]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
Use fast_string_match_ignore_case for comparing font names.
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 1999, 2000,01,02,03,04
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
134 #define XAW_ARROW_SCROLLBARS
135 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
136 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
138 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
139 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
140 #ifndef XtNpickTop
141 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
142 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
143 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
144 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
145
146 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
147
148 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
149 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
150 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
151 #endif
152
153 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
154 #include "widget.h"
155 #ifndef XtNinitialState
156 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
157 #endif
158 #endif
159
160 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
161
162 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
163 #ifdef USE_XIM
164 int use_xim = 1;
165 #else
166 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
167 #endif
168
169 \f
170
171 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
172
173 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
174
175 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
176 start. */
177
178 static int any_help_event_p;
179
180 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
181 static Lisp_Object last_window;
182
183 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
184
185 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
186
187 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
188 use. */
189
190 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
191
192 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
193 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
194 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
195 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
196
197 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
198
199 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
200 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
201 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
202 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
203
204 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
205
206 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
207
208 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
209
210 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
211 /* The application context for Xt use. */
212 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
213 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
214 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
215
216 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
217
218 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
219
220 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
221 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
222
223 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
224
225 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
226 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
227 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
228
229 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
230
231 /* Mouse movement.
232
233 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
234 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
235 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
236 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
237
238 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
239
240 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
241 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
242 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
243 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
244 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
245 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
246 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
247 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
248 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
249 is off. */
250
251 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
252
253 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
254 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
255
256 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
257
258 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
259 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
260 an ordinary motion.
261
262 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
263 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
264 event. */
265
266 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
267
268 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
269 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
270 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
271 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
272 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
273 it's somewhat accurate. */
274
275 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
276
277 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
278 events. */
279
280 #ifdef __STDC__
281 static int volatile input_signal_count;
282 #else
283 static int input_signal_count;
284 #endif
285
286 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
287
288 static int x_noop_count;
289
290 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
291
292 extern char **initial_argv;
293 extern int initial_argc;
294
295 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
296
297 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
298
299 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
300
301 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
302
303 extern int errno;
304
305 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
306
307 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
308
309 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
310
311 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
312 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
313 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
314
315 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
316 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
317
318 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
319 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
320
321 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
322 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
323 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
324 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
325 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
326 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
327 unsigned));
328 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
329 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
330 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
331 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
332 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
333 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
334 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
335 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
336 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
337 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
338 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
339 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
340 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
341 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
343 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
344 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
345 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
346 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
347 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
348 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
349 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
350 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
351 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
352 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
353 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
354 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
355 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
356 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
357 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
358 enum text_cursor_kinds));
359
360 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, GC));
361 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
362 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
363 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
364 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
365 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
366 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
367 enum scroll_bar_part *,
368 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
369 unsigned long *));
370 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
371 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
372 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
373 int *, struct input_event *));
374
375
376 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
377
378 static void
379 x_flush (f)
380 struct frame *f;
381 {
382 BLOCK_INPUT;
383 if (f == NULL)
384 {
385 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
386 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
387 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
388 }
389 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
390 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
391 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
392 }
393
394
395 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
396 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
397 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
398 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
399 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
400 performance. */
401
402 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
403
404 \f
405 /***********************************************************************
406 Debugging
407 ***********************************************************************/
408
409 #if 0
410
411 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
412 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
413
414 struct record
415 {
416 char *locus;
417 int type;
418 };
419
420 struct record event_record[100];
421
422 int event_record_index;
423
424 record_event (locus, type)
425 char *locus;
426 int type;
427 {
428 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
429 event_record_index = 0;
430
431 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
432 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
433 event_record_index++;
434 }
435
436 #endif /* 0 */
437
438
439 \f
440 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
441
442 struct x_display_info *
443 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
444 Display *dpy;
445 {
446 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
447
448 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
449 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
450 return dpyinfo;
451
452 return 0;
453 }
454
455
456 \f
457 /***********************************************************************
458 Starting and ending an update
459 ***********************************************************************/
460
461 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
462 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
463 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
464 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
465 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
466
467 static void
468 x_update_begin (f)
469 struct frame *f;
470 {
471 /* Nothing to do. */
472 }
473
474
475 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
476 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
477 position of W. */
478
479 static void
480 x_update_window_begin (w)
481 struct window *w;
482 {
483 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
484 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
485
486 updated_window = w;
487 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
488
489 BLOCK_INPUT;
490
491 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
492 {
493 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
494 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
495
496 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
497 highlighting. */
498 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
499 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
500
501 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
502 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
503 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
504 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
505 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
506 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
507
508 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
509 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
510 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
511 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
512 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
513 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
514 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
515 {
516 int i;
517
518 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
519 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
520 break;
521
522 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
523 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
524 }
525 #endif /* 0 */
526 }
527
528 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
529 }
530
531
532 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
533
534 static void
535 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
536 struct window *w;
537 int x, y0, y1;
538 {
539 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
540
541 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
542 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
543 }
544
545 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
546
547 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
548 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
549
550 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
551 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
552 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
553
554 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
555 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
556 here. */
557
558 static void
559 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
560 struct window *w;
561 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
562 {
563 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
564
565 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
566 {
567 BLOCK_INPUT;
568
569 if (cursor_on_p)
570 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
571 output_cursor.vpos,
572 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
573
574 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
575 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
576
577 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
578 }
579
580 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
581 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
582 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
583 {
584 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
585 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
586 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
587 }
588
589 updated_window = NULL;
590 }
591
592
593 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
594 update_end. */
595
596 static void
597 x_update_end (f)
598 struct frame *f;
599 {
600 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
601 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
602
603 #ifndef XFlush
604 BLOCK_INPUT;
605 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
606 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
607 #endif
608 }
609
610
611 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
612 complete update has been performed. The global variable
613 updated_window is not available here. */
614
615 static void
616 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
617 struct frame *f;
618 {
619 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
620 {
621 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
622
623 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
624 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
625 {
626 BLOCK_INPUT;
627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
628 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
629 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
630 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
631 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
632 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
633 }
634 }
635 }
636
637
638 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
639 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
640 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
641 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
642 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
643 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
644
645 static void
646 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
647 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
648 {
649 struct window *w = updated_window;
650 struct frame *f;
651 int width, height;
652
653 xassert (w);
654
655 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
656 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
657
658 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
659 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
660 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
661 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
662 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
663 overhead is very small. */
664 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
665 && desired_row->full_width_p
666 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
667 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
668 width != 0)
669 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
670 height > 0))
671 {
672 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
673
674 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
675 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
676 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
677 y -= width;
678
679 BLOCK_INPUT;
680 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
681 0, y, width, height, False);
682 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
683 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
684 y, width, height, False);
685 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
686 }
687 }
688
689 static void
690 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
691 struct window *w;
692 struct glyph_row *row;
693 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
694 {
695 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
696 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
697 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
698 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
699 struct face *face = p->face;
700 int rowY;
701
702 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
703 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
704 if (p->y < rowY)
705 {
706 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
707 visible last row. */
708 int oldY = row->y;
709 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
710 row->visible_height = p->h;
711 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
712 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
713 row->y = oldY;
714 row->visible_height = oldVH;
715 }
716 else
717 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
718
719 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
720 {
721 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
722 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
723 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
724 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
725 if (face->stipple)
726 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
727 else
728 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
729
730 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
731 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
732
733 if (!face->stipple)
734 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
735 }
736
737 if (p->which)
738 {
739 unsigned char *bits;
740 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
741 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
742 XGCValues gcv;
743
744 if (p->wd > 8)
745 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
746 else
747 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
748
749 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
750 by the server. */
751 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
752 (p->cursor_p
753 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
754 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
755 : face->foreground),
756 face->background, depth);
757
758 if (p->overlay_p)
759 {
760 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
761 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
762 bits, p->wd, p->h,
763 1, 0, 1);
764 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
765 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
766 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
767 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
768 }
769
770 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
771 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
772 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
773
774 if (p->overlay_p)
775 {
776 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
777 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
778 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
779 }
780 }
781
782 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
783 }
784
785 \f
786
787 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
788 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
789 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
790 rarely happens). */
791
792 static void
793 XTset_terminal_modes ()
794 {
795 }
796
797 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
798 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
799
800 static void
801 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
802 {
803 }
804
805
806 \f
807 /***********************************************************************
808 Display Iterator
809 ***********************************************************************/
810
811 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
812
813 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
814
815
816 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
817 is not contained in the font. */
818
819 static XCharStruct *
820 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
821 XFontStruct *font;
822 XChar2b *char2b;
823 int font_type; /* unused on X */
824 {
825 /* The result metric information. */
826 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
827
828 xassert (font && char2b);
829
830 if (font->per_char != NULL)
831 {
832 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
833 {
834 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
835 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
836 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
837 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
838 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
839 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
840 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
841 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
842 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
843 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
844 }
845 else
846 {
847 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
848 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
849 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
850 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
851
852 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
853 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
854
855 where:
856
857 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
858 / = integer division
859 \ = integer modulus */
860 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
861 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
862 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
863 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
864 {
865 pcm = (font->per_char
866 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
867 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
868 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
869 }
870 }
871 }
872 else
873 {
874 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
875 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
876 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
877 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
878 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
879 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
880 }
881
882 return ((pcm == NULL
883 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
884 ? NULL : pcm);
885 }
886
887
888 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
889 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
890
891 static int
892 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
893 int c;
894 XChar2b *char2b;
895 struct font_info *font_info;
896 int *two_byte_p;
897 {
898 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
899 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
900
901 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
902 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
903 fixed encoding. */
904 if (font_info->font_encoder)
905 {
906 /* It's a program. */
907 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
908
909 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
910 {
911 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
912 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
913 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
914 }
915 else
916 {
917 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
918 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
919 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
920 }
921
922 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
923
924 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
925 program. */
926 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
927 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
928 else
929 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
930 }
931 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
932 {
933 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
934 encoding numbers. */
935 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
936
937 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
938 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
939 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
940
941 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
942 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
943 }
944
945 if (two_byte_p)
946 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
947
948 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
949 }
950
951
952 \f
953 /***********************************************************************
954 Glyph display
955 ***********************************************************************/
956
957
958
959 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
960 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
961 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
962 int));
963 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
964 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
967 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
968 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
972 unsigned long *, double, int));
973 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
974 double, int, unsigned long));
975 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
977 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
978 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
979 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
980 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
981 int, int, int));
982 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
983 int, int, int, int, int, int,
984 XRectangle *));
985 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
986 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
987
988 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
989 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
990 #endif
991
992
993 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
994 face. */
995
996 static void
997 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
998 struct glyph_string *s;
999 {
1000 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1001 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1002 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1003 && !s->cmp)
1004 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1005 else
1006 {
1007 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1008 XGCValues xgcv;
1009 unsigned long mask;
1010
1011 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1012 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1013
1014 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1015 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1016 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1017 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1018 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1019 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1020 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1021
1022 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1023 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1024 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1025 {
1026 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1027 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1028 }
1029
1030 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1031 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1032 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1033 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1034
1035 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1036 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1037 mask, &xgcv);
1038 else
1039 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1040 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1041
1042 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1043 }
1044 }
1045
1046
1047 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1048
1049 static void
1050 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1051 struct glyph_string *s;
1052 {
1053 int face_id;
1054 struct face *face;
1055
1056 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1057 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1058 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1059 if (face == NULL)
1060 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1061
1062 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1063 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1064 else
1065 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1066 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1067 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1068
1069 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1070 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1071 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1072 else
1073 {
1074 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1075 but font FONT. */
1076 XGCValues xgcv;
1077 unsigned long mask;
1078
1079 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1080 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1081 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1082 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1083 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1084 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1085
1086 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1087 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1088 mask, &xgcv);
1089 else
1090 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1091 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1092
1093 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1094 }
1095
1096 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1097 }
1098
1099
1100 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1101 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1102 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1103
1104 static INLINE void
1105 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1106 struct glyph_string *s;
1107 {
1108 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1109 }
1110
1111
1112 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1113 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1114 pattern. */
1115
1116 static INLINE void
1117 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1118 struct glyph_string *s;
1119 {
1120 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1121
1122 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1123 {
1124 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1125 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1126 }
1127 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1128 {
1129 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 }
1132 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1133 {
1134 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1135 s->stippled_p = 0;
1136 }
1137 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1138 {
1139 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1140 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1141 }
1142 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1143 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1144 {
1145 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1146 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1147 }
1148 else
1149 {
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1152 }
1153
1154 /* GC must have been set. */
1155 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1156 }
1157
1158
1159 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1160 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1161
1162 static INLINE void
1163 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1164 struct glyph_string *s;
1165 {
1166 XRectangle r;
1167 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1168 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1169 }
1170
1171
1172 /* RIF:
1173 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1174 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1175
1176 static void
1177 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1178 struct glyph_string *s;
1179 {
1180 if (s->cmp == NULL
1181 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1182 {
1183 XCharStruct cs;
1184 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1185 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1186 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1187 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1188 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1189 }
1190 }
1191
1192
1193 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1194
1195 static INLINE void
1196 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1197 struct glyph_string *s;
1198 int x, y, w, h;
1199 {
1200 XGCValues xgcv;
1201 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1202 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1203 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1204 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1205 }
1206
1207
1208 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1209 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1210 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1211 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1212 contains the first component of a composition. */
1213
1214 static void
1215 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1216 struct glyph_string *s;
1217 int force_p;
1218 {
1219 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1220 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1221 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1222 {
1223 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1224
1225 if (s->stippled_p)
1226 {
1227 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1228 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1229 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1230 s->y + box_line_width,
1231 s->background_width,
1232 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1233 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1234 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1235 }
1236 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1237 || s->font_not_found_p
1238 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1239 || force_p)
1240 {
1241 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1242 s->background_width,
1243 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1244 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1245 }
1246 }
1247 }
1248
1249
1250 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1251
1252 static void
1253 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1254 struct glyph_string *s;
1255 {
1256 int i, x;
1257
1258 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1259 of S to the right of that box line. */
1260 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1261 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1262 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1263 else
1264 x = s->x;
1265
1266 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1267 loaded. */
1268 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1269 {
1270 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1271 {
1272 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1273 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1274 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1275 s->height - 1);
1276 x += g->pixel_width;
1277 }
1278 }
1279 else
1280 {
1281 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1282 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1283
1284 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1285 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1286
1287 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1288 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1289 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1290 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1291
1292 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1293 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1294 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1295 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1296 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1297 if (s->for_overlaps_p
1298 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1299 {
1300 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1301 if (s->two_byte_p)
1302 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1303 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1304 else
1305 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1306 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1307 }
1308 else
1309 {
1310 if (s->two_byte_p)
1311 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1312 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1313 else
1314 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1315 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1316 }
1317
1318 if (s->face->overstrike)
1319 {
1320 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1321 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1322 if (s->two_byte_p)
1323 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1324 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1325 else
1326 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1327 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1328 }
1329 }
1330 }
1331
1332 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1333
1334 static void
1335 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1336 struct glyph_string *s;
1337 {
1338 int i, x;
1339
1340 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1341 of S to the right of that box line. */
1342 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1343 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1344 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1345 else
1346 x = s->x;
1347
1348 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1349 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1350 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1351 this composition. */
1352
1353 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1354 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1355 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1356 {
1357 if (s->gidx == 0)
1358 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1359 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1360 }
1361 else
1362 {
1363 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1364 {
1365 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1366 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1367 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1368 s->char2b + i, 1);
1369 if (s->face->overstrike)
1370 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1371 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1372 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1373 s->char2b + i, 1);
1374 }
1375 }
1376 }
1377
1378
1379 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1380
1381 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1382 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1383 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1384 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1385 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1386
1387
1388 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1389 cannot be determined. */
1390
1391 static struct frame *
1392 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1393 Widget widget;
1394 {
1395 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1396 Lisp_Object tail;
1397 struct frame *f;
1398
1399 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1400
1401 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1402 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1403 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1404 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1405 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1406 widget = XtParent (widget);
1407
1408 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1409 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1410 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1411 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1412 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1413 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1414 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1415 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1416 return f;
1417
1418 abort ();
1419 }
1420
1421
1422 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1423 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1424 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1425 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1426
1427 int
1428 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1429 Widget widget;
1430 Colormap cmap;
1431 XColor *color;
1432 {
1433 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1434 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1435 }
1436
1437
1438 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1439 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1440 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1441 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1442 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1443 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1444
1445 int
1446 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1447 Widget widget;
1448 Display *display;
1449 Colormap cmap;
1450 unsigned long *pixel;
1451 double factor;
1452 int delta;
1453 {
1454 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1455 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1456 }
1457
1458
1459 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1460 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1461
1462 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1463 {
1464 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1465 sizeof (Screen *)},
1466 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1467 sizeof (Colormap)}
1468 };
1469
1470
1471 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1472 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1473
1474 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1475
1476
1477 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1478
1479 DPY is the display we are working on.
1480
1481 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1482 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1483 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1484 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1485
1486 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1487 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1488
1489 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1490 we allocated the color or not.
1491
1492 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1493
1494 static Boolean
1495 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1496 Display *dpy;
1497 XrmValue *args;
1498 Cardinal *nargs;
1499 XrmValue *from, *to;
1500 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1501 {
1502 Screen *screen;
1503 Colormap cmap;
1504 Pixel pixel;
1505 String color_name;
1506 XColor color;
1507
1508 if (*nargs != 2)
1509 {
1510 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1511 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1512 "XtToolkitError",
1513 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1514 return False;
1515 }
1516
1517 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1518 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1519 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1520
1521 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1522 {
1523 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1524 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1525 }
1526 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1527 {
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1530 }
1531 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1532 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1533 {
1534 pixel = color.pixel;
1535 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1536 }
1537 else
1538 {
1539 String params[1];
1540 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1541
1542 params[0] = color_name;
1543 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1544 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1545 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1546 params, &nparams);
1547 return False;
1548 }
1549
1550 if (to->addr != NULL)
1551 {
1552 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1553 {
1554 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1555 return False;
1556 }
1557
1558 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1559 }
1560 else
1561 {
1562 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1563 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1564 }
1565
1566 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1567 return True;
1568 }
1569
1570
1571 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1572 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1573 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1574
1575 APP is the application context in which we work.
1576
1577 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1578 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1579 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1580
1581 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1582
1583 static void
1584 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1585 XtAppContext app;
1586 XrmValuePtr to;
1587 XtPointer closure;
1588 XrmValuePtr args;
1589 Cardinal *nargs;
1590 {
1591 if (*nargs != 2)
1592 {
1593 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1594 "XtToolkitError",
1595 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1596 NULL, NULL);
1597 }
1598 else if (closure != NULL)
1599 {
1600 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1601 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1602 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1603 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1604 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1605 }
1606 }
1607
1608
1609 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1610
1611
1612 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1613 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1614 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1615 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1616
1617 static const XColor *
1618 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1619 Display *dpy;
1620 int *ncells;
1621 {
1622 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1623
1624 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1625 {
1626 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1627 int i;
1628
1629 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1630 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1631 dpyinfo->color_cells
1632 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1633 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1634
1635 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1637
1638 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1639 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1640 }
1641
1642 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1643 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1644 }
1645
1646
1647 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1648 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1649
1650 void
1651 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1652 struct frame *f;
1653 XColor *colors;
1654 int ncolors;
1655 {
1656 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1657
1658 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1659 {
1660 int i;
1661 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1662 {
1663 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1664 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1665 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1666 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1667 }
1668 }
1669 else
1670 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1671 }
1672
1673
1674 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1675 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1676
1677 void
1678 x_query_color (f, color)
1679 struct frame *f;
1680 XColor *color;
1681 {
1682 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1683 }
1684
1685
1686 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1687 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1688 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1689 allocated. */
1690
1691 static int
1692 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1693 Display *dpy;
1694 Colormap cmap;
1695 XColor *color;
1696 {
1697 int rc;
1698
1699 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1700 if (rc == 0)
1701 {
1702 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1703 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1704 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1705 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1706 int nearest, i;
1707 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1708 int ncells;
1709 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1710
1711 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1712 {
1713 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1714 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1715 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1716 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1717
1718 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1719 {
1720 nearest = i;
1721 nearest_delta = delta;
1722 }
1723 }
1724
1725 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1726 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1727 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1728 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1729 }
1730 else
1731 {
1732 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1733 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1734 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1735 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1736 XColor *cached_color;
1737
1738 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1739 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1740 (cached_color->red != color->red
1741 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1742 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1743 {
1744 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1745 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1746 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1747 }
1748 }
1749
1750 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1751 if (rc)
1752 register_color (color->pixel);
1753 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1754
1755 return rc;
1756 }
1757
1758
1759 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1760 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1761 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1762 allocated. */
1763
1764 int
1765 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1766 struct frame *f;
1767 Colormap cmap;
1768 XColor *color;
1769 {
1770 gamma_correct (f, color);
1771 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1772 }
1773
1774
1775 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1776 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1777 get color reference counts right. */
1778
1779 unsigned long
1780 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1781 struct frame *f;
1782 unsigned long pixel;
1783 {
1784 XColor color;
1785
1786 color.pixel = pixel;
1787 BLOCK_INPUT;
1788 x_query_color (f, &color);
1789 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1790 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1791 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1792 register_color (pixel);
1793 #endif
1794 return color.pixel;
1795 }
1796
1797
1798 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1799 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1800 get color reference counts right. */
1801
1802 unsigned long
1803 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1804 Display *dpy;
1805 Colormap cmap;
1806 unsigned long pixel;
1807 {
1808 XColor color;
1809
1810 color.pixel = pixel;
1811 BLOCK_INPUT;
1812 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1813 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1814 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1815 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1816 register_color (pixel);
1817 #endif
1818 return color.pixel;
1819 }
1820
1821
1822 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1823 boosted.
1824
1825 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1826 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1827 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1828 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1829 use an additional additive factor.
1830
1831 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1832 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1833 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1834
1835
1836 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1837 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1838 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1839 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1840 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1841 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1842
1843 static int
1844 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1845 struct frame *f;
1846 Display *display;
1847 Colormap cmap;
1848 unsigned long *pixel;
1849 double factor;
1850 int delta;
1851 {
1852 XColor color, new;
1853 long bright;
1854 int success_p;
1855
1856 /* Get RGB color values. */
1857 color.pixel = *pixel;
1858 x_query_color (f, &color);
1859
1860 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1861 xassert (factor >= 0);
1862 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1863 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1864 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1865
1866 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1867 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1868
1869 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1870 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1871 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1872 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1873 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1874 {
1875 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1876 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1877 /* The additive adjustment. */
1878 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1879
1880 if (factor < 1)
1881 {
1882 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1883 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1884 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1885 }
1886 else
1887 {
1888 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1889 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1890 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1891 }
1892 }
1893
1894 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1895 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1896 if (success_p)
1897 {
1898 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1899 {
1900 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1901 delta to the RGB values. */
1902 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1903
1904 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1905 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1906 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1907 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1908 }
1909 else
1910 success_p = 1;
1911 *pixel = new.pixel;
1912 }
1913
1914 return success_p;
1915 }
1916
1917
1918 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1919 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1920 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1921 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1922 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1923 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1924
1925 static void
1926 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1927 struct frame *f;
1928 struct relief *relief;
1929 double factor;
1930 int delta;
1931 unsigned long default_pixel;
1932 {
1933 XGCValues xgcv;
1934 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1935 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1936 unsigned long pixel;
1937 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1938 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1939 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1940 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1941
1942 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1943 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1944
1945 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1946 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1947 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1948 if (relief->gc
1949 && relief->allocated_p)
1950 {
1951 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1952 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1953 }
1954
1955 /* Allocate new color. */
1956 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1957 pixel = background;
1958 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1959 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1960 {
1961 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1962 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1963 }
1964
1965 if (relief->gc == 0)
1966 {
1967 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1968 mask |= GCStipple;
1969 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1970 }
1971 else
1972 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1973 }
1974
1975
1976 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1977
1978 static void
1979 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1980 struct glyph_string *s;
1981 {
1982 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1983 unsigned long color;
1984
1985 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1986 color = s->face->box_color;
1987 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1988 && s->img->pixmap
1989 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1990 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1991 else
1992 {
1993 XGCValues xgcv;
1994
1995 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1996 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1997 color = xgcv.background;
1998 }
1999
2000 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2001 || color != di->relief_background)
2002 {
2003 di->relief_background = color;
2004 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2005 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2006 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2007 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2008 }
2009 }
2010
2011
2012 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2013 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2014 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2015 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2016 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2017 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2018 when drawing. */
2019
2020 static void
2021 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2022 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2023 struct frame *f;
2024 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2025 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2026 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2027 {
2028 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2029 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2030 int i;
2031 GC gc;
2032
2033 if (raised_p)
2034 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2035 else
2036 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2037 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2038
2039 /* Top. */
2040 if (top_p)
2041 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2042 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2043 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2044 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2045
2046 /* Left. */
2047 if (left_p)
2048 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2051
2052 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2053 if (raised_p)
2054 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2055 else
2056 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2057 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2058
2059 /* Bottom. */
2060 if (bot_p)
2061 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2062 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2063 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2064 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2065
2066 /* Right. */
2067 if (right_p)
2068 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2069 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2070 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2071
2072 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2073 }
2074
2075
2076 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2077 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2078 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2079 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2080 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2081 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2082
2083 static void
2084 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2085 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2086 struct glyph_string *s;
2087 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2088 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2089 {
2090 XGCValues xgcv;
2091
2092 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2093 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2094 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2095
2096 /* Top. */
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2099
2100 /* Left. */
2101 if (left_p)
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2104
2105 /* Bottom. */
2106 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2107 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2108
2109 /* Right. */
2110 if (right_p)
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2113
2114 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2115 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2116 }
2117
2118
2119 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2120
2121 static void
2122 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2123 struct glyph_string *s;
2124 {
2125 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2126 int left_p, right_p;
2127 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2128 XRectangle clip_rect;
2129
2130 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
2131 if (s->row->full_width_p
2132 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2133 {
2134 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (s->w);
2135 if (s->area != RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
2136 || WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (s->w))
2137 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->w);
2138 }
2139
2140 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2141 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2142 ? s->first_glyph
2143 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2144
2145 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2146 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2147 left_x = s->x;
2148 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2149 ? last_x - 1
2150 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2151 top_y = s->y;
2152 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2153
2154 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2155 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2156 && (s->prev == NULL
2157 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2158 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2159 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2160 && (s->next == NULL
2161 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2162
2163 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2164
2165 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2166 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2167 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 else
2169 {
2170 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2171 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2172 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2173 }
2174 }
2175
2176
2177 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2178
2179 static void
2180 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2181 struct glyph_string *s;
2182 {
2183 int x = s->x;
2184 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2185
2186 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2187 right of that line. */
2188 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2189 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2190 && s->slice.x == 0)
2191 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2192
2193 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2194 by that margin. */
2195 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2196 x += s->img->hmargin;
2197 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2198 y += s->img->vmargin;
2199
2200 if (s->img->pixmap)
2201 {
2202 if (s->img->mask)
2203 {
2204 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2205 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2206 trust on the shape extension to be available
2207 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2208 manually. */
2209 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2210 | GCFunction);
2211 XGCValues xgcv;
2212 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2213
2214 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2215 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2216 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2217 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2218 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2219
2220 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2221 image_rect.x = x;
2222 image_rect.y = y;
2223 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2224 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2225 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2226 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2227 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2228 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2229 }
2230 else
2231 {
2232 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2233
2234 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2235 image_rect.x = x;
2236 image_rect.y = y;
2237 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2238 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2239 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2240 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2241 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2242 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2243
2244 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2245 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2246 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2247 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2248 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2249 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2250 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2251 {
2252 int r = s->img->relief;
2253 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2254 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2255 x - r, y - r,
2256 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2257 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2258 }
2259 }
2260 }
2261 else
2262 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2263 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2264 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2265 }
2266
2267
2268 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2269
2270 static void
2271 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2272 struct glyph_string *s;
2273 {
2274 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2275 XRectangle r;
2276 int x = s->x;
2277 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2278
2279 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2280 right of that line. */
2281 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2282 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2283 && s->slice.x == 0)
2284 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2285
2286 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2287 by that margin. */
2288 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2289 x += s->img->hmargin;
2290 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2291 y += s->img->vmargin;
2292
2293 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2294 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2295 {
2296 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2297 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2298 }
2299 else
2300 {
2301 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2302 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2303 }
2304
2305 x0 = x - thick;
2306 y0 = y - thick;
2307 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2308 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2309
2310 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2311 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2312 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2313 s->slice.y == 0,
2314 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2315 s->slice.x == 0,
2316 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2317 &r);
2318 }
2319
2320
2321 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2322
2323 static void
2324 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2325 struct glyph_string *s;
2326 Pixmap pixmap;
2327 {
2328 int x = 0;
2329 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2330
2331 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2332 right of that line. */
2333 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2334 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2335 && s->slice.x == 0)
2336 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2337
2338 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2339 by that margin. */
2340 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2341 x += s->img->hmargin;
2342 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2343 y += s->img->vmargin;
2344
2345 if (s->img->pixmap)
2346 {
2347 if (s->img->mask)
2348 {
2349 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2350 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2351 trust on the shape extension to be available
2352 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2353 manually. */
2354 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2355 | GCFunction);
2356 XGCValues xgcv;
2357
2358 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2359 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2360 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2361 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2362 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2363
2364 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2365 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2366 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2367 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2368 }
2369 else
2370 {
2371 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2372 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2373 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2374
2375 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2376 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2377 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2378 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2379 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2380 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2381 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2382 {
2383 int r = s->img->relief;
2384 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2385 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2386 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2387 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2388 }
2389 }
2390 }
2391 else
2392 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2393 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2394 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2395 }
2396
2397
2398 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2399 give the rectangle to draw. */
2400
2401 static void
2402 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2403 struct glyph_string *s;
2404 int x, y, w, h;
2405 {
2406 if (s->stippled_p)
2407 {
2408 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2409 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2410 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2411 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2412 }
2413 else
2414 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2415 }
2416
2417
2418 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2419
2420 s->y
2421 s->x +-------------------------
2422 | s->face->box
2423 |
2424 | +-------------------------
2425 | | s->img->margin
2426 | |
2427 | | +-------------------
2428 | | | the image
2429
2430 */
2431
2432 static void
2433 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2434 struct glyph_string *s;
2435 {
2436 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2437 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2438 int height;
2439 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2440
2441 height = s->height;
2442 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2443 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2444 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2445 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2446
2447 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2448 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2449 flickering. */
2450 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2451 if (height > s->slice.height
2452 || s->img->hmargin
2453 || s->img->vmargin
2454 || s->img->mask
2455 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2456 || s->width != s->background_width)
2457 {
2458 if (s->img->mask)
2459 {
2460 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2461 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2462 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2463 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2464 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2465
2466 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2467 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2468 s->background_width,
2469 s->height, depth);
2470
2471 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2472 pixmap. */
2473 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2474
2475 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2476 if (s->stippled_p)
2477 {
2478 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2479 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2480 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2481 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2482 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2483 }
2484 else
2485 {
2486 XGCValues xgcv;
2487 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2488 &xgcv);
2489 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2490 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2491 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2492 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2493 }
2494 }
2495 else
2496 {
2497 int x = s->x;
2498 int y = s->y;
2499
2500 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2501 && s->slice.x == 0)
2502 x += box_line_hwidth;
2503
2504 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2505 y += box_line_vwidth;
2506
2507 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2508 }
2509
2510 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2511 }
2512
2513 /* Draw the foreground. */
2514 if (pixmap != None)
2515 {
2516 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2517 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2518 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2519 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2520 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2521 }
2522 else
2523 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2524
2525 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2526 if (s->img->relief
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2528 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2529 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2530 }
2531
2532
2533 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2534
2535 static void
2536 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2537 struct glyph_string *s;
2538 {
2539 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2540 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2541
2542 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2543 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2544 {
2545 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2546 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2547 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2548
2549 /* Draw cursor. */
2550 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2551
2552 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2553 if (width < s->background_width)
2554 {
2555 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2556 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2557 XRectangle r;
2558 GC gc;
2559
2560 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2561 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2562 {
2563 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2564 gc = s->gc;
2565 }
2566 else
2567 gc = s->face->gc;
2568
2569 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2570 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2571
2572 if (s->face->stipple)
2573 {
2574 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2575 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2576 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2577 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2578 }
2579 else
2580 {
2581 XGCValues xgcv;
2582 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2583 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2584 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2585 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2586 }
2587 }
2588 }
2589 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2590 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2591 s->height);
2592
2593 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2594 }
2595
2596
2597 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2598
2599 static void
2600 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2601 struct glyph_string *s;
2602 {
2603 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2604
2605 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2606 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2607 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2608 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
2609 {
2610 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2611 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2612 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2613 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2614 }
2615
2616 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2617 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2618
2619 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2620 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2621 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
2622 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2623 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2624 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2625
2626 {
2627 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2629 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2630 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2631 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2632 }
2633 else
2634 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2635
2636 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2637 {
2638 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2639 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2640 break;
2641
2642 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2643 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2644 break;
2645
2646 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2647 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2648 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2649 else
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2651 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2652 break;
2653
2654 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2655 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
2656 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2657 else
2658 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2659 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2660 break;
2661
2662 default:
2663 abort ();
2664 }
2665
2666 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
2667 {
2668 /* Draw underline. */
2669 if (s->face->underline_p)
2670 {
2671 unsigned long tem, h;
2672 int y;
2673
2674 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2675 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2676 h = 1;
2677
2678 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2679 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2680 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2681 specs, and its default is
2682
2683 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2684 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2685
2686 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2687 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2688 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2689 else if (s->face->font)
2690 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2691 else
2692 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2693
2694 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2695 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2696 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2697 else
2698 {
2699 XGCValues xgcv;
2700 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2701 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2702 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2703 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2704 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2705 }
2706 }
2707
2708 /* Draw overline. */
2709 if (s->face->overline_p)
2710 {
2711 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2712
2713 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2714 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2715 s->width, h);
2716 else
2717 {
2718 XGCValues xgcv;
2719 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2720 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2721 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2722 s->width, h);
2723 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2724 }
2725 }
2726
2727 /* Draw strike-through. */
2728 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2729 {
2730 unsigned long h = 1;
2731 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2732
2733 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2734 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2735 s->width, h);
2736 else
2737 {
2738 XGCValues xgcv;
2739 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2740 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2741 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2742 s->width, h);
2743 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2744 }
2745 }
2746
2747 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2748 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2749 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2750 }
2751
2752 /* Reset clipping. */
2753 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2754 }
2755
2756 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2757
2758 void
2759 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2760 struct frame *f;
2761 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2762 {
2763 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2764 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2765 x, y, width, height,
2766 x + shift_by, y);
2767 }
2768
2769 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2770 for X frames. */
2771
2772 static void
2773 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2774 register int n;
2775 {
2776 abort ();
2777 }
2778
2779
2780 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2781 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2782
2783 void
2784 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2785 Display *dpy;
2786 Window window;
2787 int x, y;
2788 int width, height;
2789 int exposures;
2790 {
2791 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2792 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2793 }
2794
2795
2796 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2797 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2798
2799 static void
2800 x_clear_frame ()
2801 {
2802 struct frame *f;
2803
2804 if (updating_frame)
2805 f = updating_frame;
2806 else
2807 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2808
2809 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2810 longer visible. */
2811 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2812 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2813 output_cursor.x = -1;
2814
2815 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2816 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2817 BLOCK_INPUT;
2818 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2819
2820 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2821 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2822 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2823
2824 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2825
2826 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2827 }
2828
2829
2830 \f
2831 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2832
2833 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2834 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2835
2836 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2837
2838
2839 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2840 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2841
2842 static int
2843 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2844 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2845 {
2846 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2847 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2848 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2849 {
2850 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2851 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2852 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2853 }
2854
2855 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2856 {
2857 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2858 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2859 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2860 }
2861
2862 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2863 positive. */
2864 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2865 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2866
2867 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2868 negative. */
2869 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2870 }
2871
2872 void
2873 XTflash (f)
2874 struct frame *f;
2875 {
2876 BLOCK_INPUT;
2877
2878 {
2879 GC gc;
2880
2881 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2882 pixels into background pixels. */
2883 {
2884 XGCValues values;
2885
2886 values.function = GXxor;
2887 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2888 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2889
2890 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2891 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2892 }
2893
2894 {
2895 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2896 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2897 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2898 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2899 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2900 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2901 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2902
2903 int width;
2904
2905 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2906 edge it is next to. */
2907 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2908 {
2909 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2910 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2911 break;
2912
2913 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2914 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2915 break;
2916
2917 default:
2918 break;
2919 }
2920
2921 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2922
2923 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2924 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2925 {
2926 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2927 flash_left,
2928 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2929 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2930 width, flash_height);
2931 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2932 flash_left,
2933 (height - flash_height
2934 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2935 width, flash_height);
2936 }
2937 else
2938 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2939 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2940 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2941 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2942
2943 x_flush (f);
2944
2945 {
2946 struct timeval wakeup;
2947
2948 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2949
2950 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2951 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2952 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2953 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2954
2955 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2956 available. */
2957 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2958 {
2959 struct timeval current;
2960 struct timeval timeout;
2961
2962 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2963
2964 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2965 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2966 break;
2967
2968 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2969 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2970 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2971
2972 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2973 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2974 }
2975 }
2976
2977 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2978 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2979 {
2980 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2981 flash_left,
2982 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2983 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2984 width, flash_height);
2985 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2986 flash_left,
2987 (height - flash_height
2988 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2989 width, flash_height);
2990 }
2991 else
2992 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2993 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2994 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2995 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2996
2997 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2998 x_flush (f);
2999 }
3000 }
3001
3002 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3003 }
3004
3005 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3006
3007
3008 /* Make audible bell. */
3009
3010 void
3011 XTring_bell ()
3012 {
3013 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3014
3015 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3016 {
3017 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3018 if (visible_bell)
3019 XTflash (f);
3020 else
3021 #endif
3022 {
3023 BLOCK_INPUT;
3024 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3025 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3026 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3027 }
3028 }
3029 }
3030
3031 \f
3032 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3033 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3034 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3035 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3036
3037 static void
3038 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3039 register int n;
3040 {
3041 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3042 }
3043
3044
3045 \f
3046 /***********************************************************************
3047 Line Dance
3048 ***********************************************************************/
3049
3050 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3051 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3052
3053 static void
3054 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3055 int vpos, n;
3056 {
3057 abort ();
3058 }
3059
3060
3061 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3062
3063 static void
3064 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3065 struct window *w;
3066 struct run *run;
3067 {
3068 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3069 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3070
3071 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3072 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3073 fringe of W. */
3074 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3075
3076 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3077 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3078 bottom_y = y + height;
3079
3080 if (to_y < from_y)
3081 {
3082 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3083 line at the bottom. */
3084 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3085 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3086 else
3087 height = run->height;
3088 }
3089 else
3090 {
3091 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3092 at the bottom. */
3093 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3094 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3095 else
3096 height = run->height;
3097 }
3098
3099 BLOCK_INPUT;
3100
3101 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3102 updated_window = w;
3103 x_clear_cursor (w);
3104
3105 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3106 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3107 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3108 x, from_y,
3109 width, height,
3110 x, to_y);
3111
3112 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3113 }
3114
3115
3116 \f
3117 /***********************************************************************
3118 Exposure Events
3119 ***********************************************************************/
3120
3121 \f
3122 static void
3123 frame_highlight (f)
3124 struct frame *f;
3125 {
3126 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3127 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3128 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3129 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3130 BLOCK_INPUT;
3131 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3132 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3133 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3134 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3135 }
3136
3137 static void
3138 frame_unhighlight (f)
3139 struct frame *f;
3140 {
3141 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3142 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3143 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3144 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3145 BLOCK_INPUT;
3146 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3147 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3148 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3149 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3150 }
3151
3152 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3153 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3154 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3155 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3156 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3157
3158 static void
3159 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3160 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3161 struct frame *frame;
3162 {
3163 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3164
3165 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3166 {
3167 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3168 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3169 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3170
3171 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3172 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3173
3174 #if 0
3175 selected_frame = frame;
3176 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3177 selected_frame);
3178 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3179 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3180 #endif /* ! 0 */
3181
3182 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3183 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3184 else
3185 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3186 }
3187
3188 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3189 }
3190
3191 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3192 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3193 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3194
3195 static void
3196 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3197 int type;
3198 int state;
3199 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3200 struct frame *frame;
3201 struct input_event *bufp;
3202 {
3203 if (type == FocusIn)
3204 {
3205 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3206 {
3207 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3208 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3209
3210 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3211 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3212 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3213 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3214 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3215 {
3216 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3217 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3218 }
3219 }
3220
3221 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3222
3223 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3224 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3225 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3226 #endif
3227 }
3228 else if (type == FocusOut)
3229 {
3230 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3231
3232 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3233 {
3234 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3235 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3236 }
3237
3238 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3239 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3240 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3241 #endif
3242 }
3243 }
3244
3245 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3246 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3247
3248 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3249
3250 static void
3251 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3252 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3253 XEvent *event;
3254 struct input_event *bufp;
3255 {
3256 struct frame *frame;
3257
3258 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3259 if (! frame)
3260 return;
3261
3262 switch (event->type)
3263 {
3264 case EnterNotify:
3265 case LeaveNotify:
3266 {
3267 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3268 int focus_state
3269 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3270
3271 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3272 && event->xcrossing.focus
3273 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3274 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3275 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3276 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3277 }
3278 break;
3279
3280 case FocusIn:
3281 case FocusOut:
3282 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3283 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3284 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3285 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3286 break;
3287 }
3288 }
3289
3290
3291 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3292
3293 void
3294 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3295 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3296 {
3297 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3298 }
3299
3300 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3301 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3302 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3303
3304 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3305 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3306 the appropriate X display info. */
3307
3308 static void
3309 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3310 struct frame *frame;
3311 {
3312 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3313 }
3314
3315 static void
3316 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3317 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3318 {
3319 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3320
3321 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3322 {
3323 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3324 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3325 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3326 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3327 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3328 {
3329 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3330 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3331 }
3332 }
3333 else
3334 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3335
3336 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3337 {
3338 if (old_highlight)
3339 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3340 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3341 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3342 }
3343 }
3344
3345
3346 \f
3347 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3348
3349 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3350 static void
3351 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3352 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3353 {
3354 int min_code, max_code;
3355 KeySym *syms;
3356 int syms_per_code;
3357 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3358
3359 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3360 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3361 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3362 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3363 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3364
3365 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3366 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3367 #else
3368 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3369 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3370 #endif
3371
3372 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3373 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3374 &syms_per_code);
3375 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3376
3377 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3378 Alt keysyms are on. */
3379 {
3380 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3381 int found_alt_or_meta;
3382
3383 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3384 {
3385 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3386 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3387 {
3388 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3389
3390 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3391 if (code == 0)
3392 continue;
3393
3394 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3395 {
3396 int code_col;
3397
3398 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3399 {
3400 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3401
3402 switch (sym)
3403 {
3404 case XK_Meta_L:
3405 case XK_Meta_R:
3406 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3407 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3408 break;
3409
3410 case XK_Alt_L:
3411 case XK_Alt_R:
3412 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3413 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3414 break;
3415
3416 case XK_Hyper_L:
3417 case XK_Hyper_R:
3418 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3419 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3420 code_col = syms_per_code;
3421 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3422 break;
3423
3424 case XK_Super_L:
3425 case XK_Super_R:
3426 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3427 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3428 code_col = syms_per_code;
3429 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3430 break;
3431
3432 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3433 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3434 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3435 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3436 code_col = syms_per_code;
3437 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3438 break;
3439 }
3440 }
3441 }
3442 }
3443 }
3444 }
3445
3446 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3447 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3448 {
3449 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3450 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3451 }
3452
3453 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3454 make them just meta, not alt. */
3455 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3456 {
3457 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3458 }
3459
3460 XFree ((char *) syms);
3461 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3462 }
3463
3464 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3465 Emacs uses. */
3466
3467 static unsigned int
3468 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3469 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3470 unsigned int state;
3471 {
3472 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3473 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3474 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3475 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3476 Lisp_Object tem;
3477
3478 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3479 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3480 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3481 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3482 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3483 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3484 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3485 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3486
3487
3488 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3489 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3490 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3491 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3492 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3493 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3494 }
3495
3496 static unsigned int
3497 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3498 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3499 unsigned int state;
3500 {
3501 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3502 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3503 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3504 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3505
3506 Lisp_Object tem;
3507
3508 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3509 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3510 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3511 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3512 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3513 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3514 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3515 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3516
3517
3518 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3519 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3520 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3521 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3522 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3523 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3524 }
3525
3526 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3527
3528 char *
3529 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3530 KeySym keysym;
3531 {
3532 char *value;
3533
3534 BLOCK_INPUT;
3535 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3536 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3537
3538 return value;
3539 }
3540
3541
3542 \f
3543 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3544
3545 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3546
3547 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3548 the mouse. */
3549
3550 static Lisp_Object
3551 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3552 struct input_event *result;
3553 XButtonEvent *event;
3554 struct frame *f;
3555 {
3556 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3557 otherwise. */
3558 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3559 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3560 result->timestamp = event->time;
3561 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3562 event->state)
3563 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3564 ? up_modifier
3565 : down_modifier));
3566
3567 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3568 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3569 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3570 result->arg = Qnil;
3571 return Qnil;
3572 }
3573
3574 \f
3575 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3576 The input handler calls this.
3577
3578 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3579 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3580 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3581 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3582
3583 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3584 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3585
3586 static void
3587 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3588 FRAME_PTR frame;
3589 XMotionEvent *event;
3590 {
3591 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3592 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3593 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3594
3595 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3596 {
3597 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3598 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3599 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3600 }
3601
3602 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3603 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3604 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3605 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3606 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3607 {
3608 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3609 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3610 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3611 }
3612 }
3613
3614 \f
3615 /************************************************************************
3616 Mouse Face
3617 ************************************************************************/
3618
3619 static void
3620 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3621 {
3622 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3623 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3624 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3625 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3626 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3627 }
3628
3629
3630 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
3631
3632
3633 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
3634 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
3635 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
3636 values. */
3637
3638 static int
3639 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
3640 struct frame *f;
3641 int x, y;
3642 XRectangle *rect;
3643 {
3644 Lisp_Object window;
3645 struct window *w;
3646 struct glyph_row *r, *end_row;
3647
3648 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, &x, &y, 0);
3649 if (NILP (window))
3650 return 0;
3651
3652 w = XWINDOW (window);
3653 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
3654 end_row = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
3655
3656 for (; r < end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
3657 {
3658 if (r->y >= y)
3659 {
3660 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
3661 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
3662 int gx = r->x;
3663 while (g < end && gx < x)
3664 gx += g->pixel_width, ++g;
3665 if (g < end)
3666 {
3667 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
3668 rect->height = r->height;
3669 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
3670 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
3671 return 1;
3672 }
3673 break;
3674 }
3675 }
3676
3677 return 0;
3678 }
3679
3680
3681 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3682 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3683
3684 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3685 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3686 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3687 position on the scroll bar.
3688
3689 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3690 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3691 the mouse is over.
3692
3693 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3694 was at this position.
3695
3696 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3697
3698 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3699 movement. */
3700
3701 static void
3702 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3703 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3704 int insist;
3705 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3706 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3707 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3708 unsigned long *time;
3709 {
3710 FRAME_PTR f1;
3711
3712 BLOCK_INPUT;
3713
3714 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3715 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3716 else
3717 {
3718 Window root;
3719 int root_x, root_y;
3720
3721 Window dummy_window;
3722 int dummy;
3723
3724 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3725
3726 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3727 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3728 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3729 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3730
3731 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3732
3733 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3734 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3735 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3736
3737 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3738 &root,
3739
3740 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3741 a different screen. */
3742 &dummy_window,
3743
3744 /* The position on that root window. */
3745 &root_x, &root_y,
3746
3747 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3748 &dummy, &dummy,
3749
3750 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3751 we don't care. */
3752 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3753
3754 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3755 containing the pointer. */
3756 {
3757 Window win, child;
3758 int win_x, win_y;
3759 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3760 int count;
3761
3762 win = root;
3763
3764 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3765 structure is changing at the same time this function
3766 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3767
3768 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3769
3770 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3771 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3772 {
3773 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3774 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3775 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3776
3777 /* From-window, to-window. */
3778 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3779
3780 /* From-position, to-position. */
3781 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3782
3783 /* Child of win. */
3784 &child);
3785 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3786 }
3787 else
3788 {
3789 while (1)
3790 {
3791 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3792
3793 /* From-window, to-window. */
3794 root, win,
3795
3796 /* From-position, to-position. */
3797 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3798
3799 /* Child of win. */
3800 &child);
3801
3802 if (child == None || child == win)
3803 break;
3804
3805 win = child;
3806 parent_x = win_x;
3807 parent_y = win_y;
3808 }
3809
3810 /* Now we know that:
3811 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3812 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3813 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3814 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3815 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3816 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3817 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3818 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3819 never use them in that case.) */
3820
3821 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3822 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3823
3824 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3825 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3826 on the frame. */
3827 if (f1 != NULL
3828 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3829 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3830 f1 = NULL;
3831 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3832 }
3833
3834 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3835 f1 = 0;
3836
3837 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3838
3839 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3840 if (! f1)
3841 {
3842 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3843
3844 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3845
3846 if (bar)
3847 {
3848 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3849 win_x = parent_x;
3850 win_y = parent_y;
3851 }
3852 }
3853
3854 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3855 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3856
3857 if (f1)
3858 {
3859 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3860 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3861 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3862 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3863 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3864 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3865 the frame are divided into. */
3866
3867 int width, height, gx, gy;
3868 XRectangle rect;
3869
3870 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
3871 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
3872 else
3873 {
3874 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
3875 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
3876 gx = win_x;
3877 gy = win_y;
3878
3879 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
3880 round down even for negative values. */
3881 if (gx < 0)
3882 gx -= width - 1;
3883 if (gy < 0)
3884 gy -= height - 1;
3885 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
3886 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
3887
3888 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
3889 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
3890 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
3891 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
3892 }
3893
3894 *bar_window = Qnil;
3895 *part = 0;
3896 *fp = f1;
3897 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3898 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3899 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3900 }
3901 }
3902 }
3903
3904 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3905 }
3906
3907
3908 \f
3909 /***********************************************************************
3910 Scroll bars
3911 ***********************************************************************/
3912
3913 /* Scroll bar support. */
3914
3915 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3916 manages it.
3917 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3918 bits. */
3919
3920 static struct scroll_bar *
3921 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3922 Display *display;
3923 Window window_id;
3924 {
3925 Lisp_Object tail;
3926
3927 #ifdef USE_GTK
3928 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3929 #endif /* USE_GTK */
3930
3931 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3932 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3933 tail = XCDR (tail))
3934 {
3935 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3936
3937 frame = XCAR (tail);
3938 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3939 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3940 abort ();
3941
3942 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3943 right window ID. */
3944 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3945 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3946 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3947 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3948 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3949 condemned = Qnil,
3950 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3951 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3952 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3953 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3954 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3955 }
3956
3957 return 0;
3958 }
3959
3960
3961 #if defined USE_LUCID
3962
3963 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3964 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3965
3966 static Widget
3967 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3968 Window window;
3969 {
3970 Lisp_Object tail;
3971
3972 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3973 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3974 tail = XCDR (tail))
3975 {
3976 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3977 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3978
3979 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3980 return menu_bar;
3981 }
3982
3983 return NULL;
3984 }
3985
3986 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3987
3988 \f
3989 /************************************************************************
3990 Toolkit scroll bars
3991 ************************************************************************/
3992
3993 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3994
3995 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3996 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3997 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3998 struct scroll_bar *));
3999 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
4000 int, int, int));
4001
4002
4003 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4004 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4005
4006 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4007
4008 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4009
4010 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4011
4012 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4013 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4014
4015 #ifndef USE_GTK
4016 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4017
4018 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4019
4020 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4021
4022 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4023 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4024 to avoid jerkyness. */
4025
4026 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4027
4028 extern void set_vertical_scroll_bar P_ ((struct window *));
4029
4030 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4031 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4032 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4033 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4034
4035 static void
4036 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
4037 num_params)
4038 Widget widget;
4039 XtPointer client_data;
4040 String action_name;
4041 XEvent *event;
4042 String *params;
4043 Cardinal *num_params;
4044 {
4045 int scroll_bar_p;
4046 char *end_action;
4047
4048 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4049 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4050 end_action = "Release";
4051 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4052 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4053 end_action = "EndScroll";
4054 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4055
4056 if (scroll_bar_p
4057 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4058 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4059 {
4060 struct window *w;
4061
4062 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4063 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4064 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4065
4066 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4067 {
4068 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4069 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4070 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4071 }
4072 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4073 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4074
4075 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4076 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4077 }
4078 }
4079 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4080
4081 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4082 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4083
4084 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4085 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4086
4087
4088 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4089 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4090 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4091 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4092
4093 static void
4094 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4095 Lisp_Object window;
4096 int part, portion, whole;
4097 {
4098 XEvent event;
4099 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4100 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4101 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4102 int i;
4103
4104 BLOCK_INPUT;
4105
4106 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4107 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4108 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4109 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4110 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4111 ev->format = 32;
4112
4113 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4114 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4115 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4116 into that array in the event. */
4117 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4118 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4119 break;
4120
4121 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4122 {
4123 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4124 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4125 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4126
4127 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4128 nbytes);
4129 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4130 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4131 }
4132
4133 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4134 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4135 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4136 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4137 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4138 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4139
4140 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4141 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4142
4143 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4144 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4145 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4146 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4148 }
4149
4150
4151 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4152 in *IEVENT. */
4153
4154 static void
4155 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4156 XEvent *event;
4157 struct input_event *ievent;
4158 {
4159 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4160 Lisp_Object window;
4161 struct frame *f;
4162 struct window *w;
4163
4164 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4165 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4166
4167 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4168 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4169
4170 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4171 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4172 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4173 #ifdef USE_GTK
4174 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4175 #else
4176 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4177 #endif
4178 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4179 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4180 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4181 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4182 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4183 }
4184
4185
4186 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4187
4188 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4189
4190 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4191
4192
4193 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4194 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4195 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4196
4197 static void
4198 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4199 Widget widget;
4200 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4201 {
4202 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4203 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4204 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4205
4206 switch (cs->reason)
4207 {
4208 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4209 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4210 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4211 break;
4212
4213 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4214 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4215 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4216 break;
4217
4218 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4219 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4220 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4221 break;
4222
4223 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4224 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4225 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4226 break;
4227
4228 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4229 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4230 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4231 break;
4232
4233 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4234 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4235 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4236 break;
4237
4238 case XmCR_DRAG:
4239 {
4240 int slider_size;
4241
4242 /* Get the slider size. */
4243 BLOCK_INPUT;
4244 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4245 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4246
4247 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4248 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4249 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4250 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4251 }
4252 break;
4253
4254 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4255 break;
4256 };
4257
4258 if (part >= 0)
4259 {
4260 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4261 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4262 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4263 }
4264 }
4265
4266
4267 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4268 #ifdef USE_GTK
4269 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4270 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4271
4272 static void
4273 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4274 GtkRange *widget;
4275 gpointer data;
4276 {
4277 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4278 gdouble previous;
4279 gdouble position;
4280 gdouble *p;
4281 int diff;
4282
4283 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4284 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4285
4286 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4287
4288 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4289
4290 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4291 if (! p)
4292 {
4293 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4294 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4295 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4296 }
4297
4298 previous = *p;
4299 *p = position;
4300
4301 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4302
4303 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4304 {
4305 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4306 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4307 }
4308 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4309 {
4310 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4311 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4312 }
4313 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4314 {
4315 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4316 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4317 }
4318 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4319 {
4320 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4321 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4322 }
4323 else
4324 {
4325 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4326 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4327 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4328 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4329 }
4330
4331 if (part >= 0)
4332 {
4333 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4334 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4335 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4336 }
4337 }
4338
4339 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4340
4341 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4342 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4343 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4344 the thumb is. */
4345
4346 static void
4347 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4348 Widget widget;
4349 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4350 {
4351 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4352 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4353 float shown;
4354 int whole, portion, height;
4355 int part;
4356
4357 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4358 BLOCK_INPUT;
4359 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4360 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4361
4362 whole = 10000000;
4363 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4364
4365 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4366 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4367 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4368 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4369 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4370 bottom). */
4371 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4372 else
4373 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4374
4375 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4376 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4377 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4378 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4379 }
4380
4381
4382 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4383 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4384 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4385 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4386 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4387 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4388 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4389
4390 static void
4391 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4392 Widget widget;
4393 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4394 {
4395 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4396 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4397 int position = (long) call_data;
4398 Dimension height;
4399 int part;
4400
4401 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4402 BLOCK_INPUT;
4403 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4404 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4405
4406 if (abs (position) >= height)
4407 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4408
4409 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4410 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4411 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4412 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4413 else
4414 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4415
4416 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4417 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4418 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4419 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4420 }
4421
4422 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4423 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4424
4425 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4426
4427 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4428 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4429
4430 #ifdef USE_GTK
4431 static void
4432 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4433 struct frame *f;
4434 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4435 {
4436 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4437
4438 BLOCK_INPUT;
4439 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4440 scroll_bar_name);
4441 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4442 }
4443
4444 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4445
4446 static void
4447 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4448 struct frame *f;
4449 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4450 {
4451 Window xwindow;
4452 Widget widget;
4453 Arg av[20];
4454 int ac = 0;
4455 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4456 unsigned long pixel;
4457
4458 BLOCK_INPUT;
4459
4460 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4461 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4462 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4463 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4464 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4465 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4466 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4467 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4468 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4469
4470 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4471 if (pixel != -1)
4472 {
4473 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4474 ++ac;
4475 }
4476
4477 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4478 if (pixel != -1)
4479 {
4480 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4481 ++ac;
4482 }
4483
4484 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4485 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4486
4487 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4488 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4489 (XtPointer) bar);
4490 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4491 (XtPointer) bar);
4492 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4493 (XtPointer) bar);
4494 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4495 (XtPointer) bar);
4496 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4497 (XtPointer) bar);
4498 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4499 (XtPointer) bar);
4500 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4501 (XtPointer) bar);
4502
4503 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4504 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4505
4506 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4507 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4508 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4509 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4510
4511 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4512
4513 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4514 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4515 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4516 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4517 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4518 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4519 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4520 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4521
4522 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4523 if (pixel != -1)
4524 {
4525 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4526 ++ac;
4527 }
4528
4529 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4530 if (pixel != -1)
4531 {
4532 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4533 ++ac;
4534 }
4535
4536 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4537
4538 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4539 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4540 {
4541 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4542 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4543 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4544 pixel = -1;
4545 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4546 }
4547 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4548 {
4549 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4550 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4551 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4552 pixel = -1;
4553 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4554 }
4555
4556 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4557 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4558 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4559 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4560 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4561 {
4562 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4563 ++ac;
4564 }
4565 else
4566 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4567 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4568 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4569 {
4570 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4571 the shadows. */
4572 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4573 ++ac;
4574
4575 /* Specify the colors. */
4576 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4577 if (pixel != -1)
4578 {
4579 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
4580 ++ac;
4581 }
4582 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4583 if (pixel != -1)
4584 {
4585 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
4586 ++ac;
4587 }
4588 }
4589
4590 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4591 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4592
4593 {
4594 char *initial = "";
4595 char *val = initial;
4596 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4597 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4598 if (val == initial)
4599 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4600 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4601 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
4602 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4603 }
4604 }
4605
4606 /* Define callbacks. */
4607 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4608 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4609 (XtPointer) bar);
4610
4611 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4612 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4613
4614 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4615
4616 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4617 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4618 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4619 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4620
4621 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4622 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4623 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4624 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4625
4626 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4627 }
4628 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4629
4630
4631 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4632 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4633
4634 #ifdef USE_GTK
4635 static void
4636 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4637 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4638 int portion, position, whole;
4639 {
4640 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4641 }
4642
4643 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4644 static void
4645 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4646 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4647 int portion, position, whole;
4648 {
4649 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4650 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4651 float top, shown;
4652
4653 BLOCK_INPUT;
4654
4655 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4656
4657 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4658 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4659 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4660 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4661 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4662 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4663 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4664 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4665 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4666 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4667 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4668 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4669 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4670 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4671 whole += portion;
4672
4673 if (whole <= 0)
4674 top = 0, shown = 1;
4675 else
4676 {
4677 top = (float) position / whole;
4678 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4679 }
4680
4681 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4682 {
4683 int size, value;
4684
4685 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4686 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4687 value. */
4688 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4689 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4690 size = max (size, 1);
4691
4692 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4693 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4694 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4695
4696 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4697 }
4698 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4699
4700 if (whole == 0)
4701 top = 0, shown = 1;
4702 else
4703 {
4704 top = (float) position / whole;
4705 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4706 }
4707
4708 {
4709 float old_top, old_shown;
4710 Dimension height;
4711 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4712 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4713 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4714 XtNheight, &height,
4715 NULL);
4716
4717 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4718 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4719 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4720 else
4721 top = old_top;
4722 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4723 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4724
4725 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4726 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4727 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4728 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4729 {
4730 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4731 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4732 else
4733 {
4734 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4735 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
4736 int scroll_mode = 0;
4737
4738 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
4739 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
4740 {
4741 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
4742 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
4743 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
4744 if (scroll_mode == 2)
4745 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
4746 }
4747 #endif
4748 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4749 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4750 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4751
4752 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4753
4754 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4755 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
4756 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
4757 #endif
4758 }
4759 }
4760 }
4761 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4762
4763 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4764 }
4765 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4766
4767 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4768
4769
4770 \f
4771 /************************************************************************
4772 Scroll bars, general
4773 ************************************************************************/
4774
4775 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4776 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4777 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4778 scroll bar. */
4779
4780 static struct scroll_bar *
4781 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4782 struct window *w;
4783 int top, left, width, height;
4784 {
4785 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4786 struct scroll_bar *bar
4787 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4788
4789 BLOCK_INPUT;
4790
4791 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4792 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4793 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4794 {
4795 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4796 unsigned long mask;
4797 Window window;
4798
4799 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4800 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4801 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4802
4803 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4804 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4805 | ExposureMask);
4806 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4807
4808 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4809
4810 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4811 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4812 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4813 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4814 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4815 left, top, width,
4816 window_box_height (w), False);
4817
4818 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4819 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4820 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4821 top,
4822 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4823 height,
4824 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4825 0,
4826 CopyFromParent,
4827 CopyFromParent,
4828 CopyFromParent,
4829 /* Attributes. */
4830 mask, &a);
4831 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4832 }
4833 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4834
4835 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4836 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4837 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4838 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4839 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4840 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4841 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4842 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4843
4844 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4845 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4846 bar->prev = Qnil;
4847 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4848 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4849 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4850
4851 /* Map the window/widget. */
4852 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4853 {
4854 #ifdef USE_GTK
4855 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4856 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4857 top,
4858 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4859 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4860 max (height, 1));
4861 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4862 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4863 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4864 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4865 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4866 top,
4867 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4868 max (height, 1), 0);
4869 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4870 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4871 }
4872 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4873 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4874 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4875
4876 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4877 return bar;
4878 }
4879
4880
4881 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4882
4883 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4884 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4885 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4886 events.)
4887
4888 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4889 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4890 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4891 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4892 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4893
4894 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4895
4896 static void
4897 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4898 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4899 int start, end;
4900 int rebuild;
4901 {
4902 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4903 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4904 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4905 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4906
4907 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4908 if (! rebuild
4909 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4910 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4911 return;
4912
4913 BLOCK_INPUT;
4914
4915 {
4916 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4917 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4918 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4919
4920 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4921 the distance between start and end. */
4922 {
4923 int length = end - start;
4924
4925 if (start < 0)
4926 start = 0;
4927 else if (start > top_range)
4928 start = top_range;
4929 end = start + length;
4930
4931 if (end < start)
4932 end = start;
4933 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4934 end = top_range;
4935 }
4936
4937 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4938 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4939 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4940
4941 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4942 if (end > top_range)
4943 end = top_range;
4944
4945 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4946 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4947 that many pixels tall. */
4948 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4949
4950 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4951 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4952 if (0 < start)
4953 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4954 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4955 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4956 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4957 inside_width, start,
4958 False);
4959
4960 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4961 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4962 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4963 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4964
4965 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4966 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4967 /* x, y, width, height */
4968 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4969 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4970 inside_width, end - start);
4971
4972 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4973 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4974 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4975 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4976
4977 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4978 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4979 if (end < inside_height)
4980 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4981 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4982 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4983 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4984 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4985 False);
4986
4987 }
4988
4989 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4990 }
4991
4992 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4993
4994 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4995 nil. */
4996
4997 static void
4998 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4999 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5000 {
5001 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5002 BLOCK_INPUT;
5003
5004 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5005 #ifdef USE_GTK
5006 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
5007 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5008 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5009 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5010 #else
5011 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
5012 #endif
5013
5014 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5015 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5016
5017 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5018 }
5019
5020
5021 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5022 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5023 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5024 create one. */
5025
5026 static void
5027 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
5028 struct window *w;
5029 int portion, whole, position;
5030 {
5031 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5032 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5033 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5034 int window_y, window_height;
5035
5036 /* Get window dimensions. */
5037 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5038 top = window_y;
5039 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5040 height = window_height;
5041
5042 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5043 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5044
5045 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5046 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5047 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5048 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5049 else
5050 sb_width = width;
5051
5052 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5053 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5054 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5055 sb_left = (left +
5056 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5057 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
5058 : 0));
5059 else
5060 sb_left = (left +
5061 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5062 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
5063 : width - sb_width));
5064 #else
5065 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5066 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5067 else
5068 sb_left = left;
5069 #endif
5070
5071 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5072 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5073 {
5074 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5075 {
5076 BLOCK_INPUT;
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left, top, width, height, False);
5079 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5080 }
5081
5082 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5083 }
5084 else
5085 {
5086 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5087 unsigned int mask = 0;
5088
5089 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5090
5091 BLOCK_INPUT;
5092
5093 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5094 mask |= CWX;
5095 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5096 mask |= CWY;
5097 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5098 mask |= CWWidth;
5099 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5100 mask |= CWHeight;
5101
5102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5103
5104 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5105 if (mask)
5106 {
5107 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5108 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5109 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5110 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5111 left, top, width, height, False);
5112 #ifdef USE_GTK
5113 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5114 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5115 top,
5116 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5117 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5118 max (height, 1));
5119 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5120 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5121 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5122 top,
5123 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5124 max (height, 1), 0);
5125 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5126 }
5127 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5128
5129 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5130 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5131 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5132 {
5133 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5134 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5135 height, False);
5136 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5137 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5138 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5139 height, False);
5140 }
5141
5142 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5143 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5144 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5145 example. */
5146 {
5147 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5148 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5149 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5150 {
5151 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5152 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5153 left + area_width - rest, top,
5154 rest, height, False);
5155 else
5156 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5157 left, top, rest, height, False);
5158 }
5159 }
5160
5161 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5162 if (mask)
5163 {
5164 XWindowChanges wc;
5165
5166 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5167 wc.y = top;
5168 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5169 wc.height = height;
5170 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5171 mask, &wc);
5172 }
5173
5174 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5175
5176 /* Remember new settings. */
5177 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5178 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5179 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5180 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5181
5182 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5183 }
5184
5185 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5186 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5187 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5188 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5189 dragged. */
5190 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5191 {
5192 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5193
5194 if (whole == 0)
5195 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5196 else
5197 {
5198 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5199 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5200 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5201 }
5202 }
5203 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5204
5205 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5206 }
5207
5208
5209 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5210 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5211 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5212 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5213 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5214 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5215 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5216
5217 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5218 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5219 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5220
5221 static void
5222 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5223 FRAME_PTR frame;
5224 {
5225 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5226 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5227 {
5228 Lisp_Object bar;
5229 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5230 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5231 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5232 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5233 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5234 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5235 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5236 }
5237 }
5238
5239
5240 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5241 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5242
5243 static void
5244 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5245 struct window *window;
5246 {
5247 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5248 struct frame *f;
5249
5250 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5251 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5252 abort ();
5253
5254 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5255
5256 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5257 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5258 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5259 {
5260 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5261 the lists. */
5262 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5263 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5264 return;
5265 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5266 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5267 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5268 else
5269 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5270 one or the other! */
5271 abort ();
5272 }
5273 else
5274 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5275
5276 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5277 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5278
5279 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5280 bar->prev = Qnil;
5281 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5282 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5283 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5284 }
5285
5286 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5287 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5288
5289 static void
5290 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5291 FRAME_PTR f;
5292 {
5293 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5294
5295 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5296
5297 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5298 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5299 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5300
5301 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5302 {
5303 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5304
5305 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5306
5307 next = b->next;
5308 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5309 }
5310
5311 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5312 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5313 }
5314
5315
5316 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5317 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5318 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5319
5320 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5321 mark bits. */
5322
5323 static void
5324 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5325 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5326 XEvent *event;
5327 {
5328 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5329 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5330 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5331 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5332
5333 BLOCK_INPUT;
5334
5335 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5336
5337 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5338 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5339
5340 /* x, y, width, height */
5341 0, 0,
5342 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5343 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5344
5345 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5346
5347 }
5348 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5349
5350 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5351 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5352
5353 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5354 mark bits. */
5355
5356
5357 static void
5358 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5359 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5360 XEvent *event;
5361 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5362 {
5363 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5364 abort ();
5365
5366 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5367 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5368 emacs_event->modifiers
5369 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5370 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5371 event->xbutton.state)
5372 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5373 ? up_modifier
5374 : down_modifier));
5375 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5376 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5377 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5378 {
5379 #if 0
5380 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5381 int internal_height
5382 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5383 #endif
5384 int top_range
5385 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5386 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5387
5388 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5389 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5390
5391 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5392 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5393 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5394 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5395 else
5396 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5397
5398 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5399 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5400 whether or not we're dragging. */
5401 #if 0
5402 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5403 holding it. */
5404 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5405 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5406 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5407 #endif
5408
5409 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5410 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5411 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5412 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5413 {
5414 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5415 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5416
5417 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5418 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5419 }
5420 #endif
5421
5422 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5423 #if 0
5424 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5425 the handle. */
5426 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5427 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5428 else
5429 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5430 #else
5431 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5432 #endif
5433
5434 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5435 }
5436 }
5437
5438 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5439
5440 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5441
5442 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5443 mark bits. */
5444
5445 static void
5446 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5447 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5448 XEvent *event;
5449 {
5450 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5451
5452 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5453
5454 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5455 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5456
5457 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5458 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5459 {
5460 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5461 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5462
5463 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5464 {
5465 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5466
5467 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5468 }
5469 }
5470 }
5471
5472 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5473
5474 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5475 on the scroll bar. */
5476
5477 static void
5478 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5479 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5480 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5481 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5482 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5483 unsigned long *time;
5484 {
5485 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5486 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5487 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5488 int win_x, win_y;
5489 Window dummy_window;
5490 int dummy_coord;
5491 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5492
5493 BLOCK_INPUT;
5494
5495 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5496 report that. */
5497 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5498
5499 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5500 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5501 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5502
5503 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5504 &win_x, &win_y,
5505
5506 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5507 &dummy_mask))
5508 ;
5509 else
5510 {
5511 #if 0
5512 int inside_height
5513 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5514 #endif
5515 int top_range
5516 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5517
5518 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5519
5520 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5521 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5522
5523 if (win_y < 0)
5524 win_y = 0;
5525 if (win_y > top_range)
5526 win_y = top_range;
5527
5528 *fp = f;
5529 *bar_window = bar->window;
5530
5531 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5532 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5533 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5534 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5535 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5536 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5537 else
5538 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5539
5540 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5541 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5542
5543 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5544 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5545 }
5546
5547 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5548
5549 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5550 }
5551
5552
5553 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5554 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5555 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5556 redraw them. */
5557
5558 void
5559 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5560 FRAME_PTR f;
5561 {
5562 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5563 Lisp_Object bar;
5564
5565 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5566 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5567 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5568 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5569 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5570 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5571 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5572 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5573 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5574 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5575 }
5576
5577 \f
5578 /* Define a queue to save up SelectionRequest events for later handling. */
5579
5580 struct selection_event_queue
5581 {
5582 XEvent event;
5583 struct selection_event_queue *next;
5584 };
5585
5586 static struct selection_event_queue *queue;
5587
5588 /* Nonzero means queue up certain events--don't process them yet. */
5589
5590 static int x_queue_selection_requests;
5591
5592 /* Queue up an X event *EVENT, to be processed later. */
5593
5594 static void
5595 x_queue_event (f, event)
5596 FRAME_PTR f;
5597 XEvent *event;
5598 {
5599 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp
5600 = (struct selection_event_queue *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct selection_event_queue));
5601
5602 if (queue_tmp != NULL)
5603 {
5604 queue_tmp->event = *event;
5605 queue_tmp->next = queue;
5606 queue = queue_tmp;
5607 }
5608 }
5609
5610 /* Take all the queued events and put them back
5611 so that they get processed afresh. */
5612
5613 static void
5614 x_unqueue_events (display)
5615 Display *display;
5616 {
5617 while (queue != NULL)
5618 {
5619 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp = queue;
5620 XPutBackEvent (display, &queue_tmp->event);
5621 queue = queue_tmp->next;
5622 xfree ((char *)queue_tmp);
5623 }
5624 }
5625
5626 /* Start queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5627
5628 void
5629 x_start_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5630 Display *display;
5631 {
5632 x_queue_selection_requests++;
5633 }
5634
5635 /* Stop queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5636
5637 void
5638 x_stop_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5639 Display *display;
5640 {
5641 x_queue_selection_requests--;
5642 x_unqueue_events (display);
5643 }
5644 \f
5645 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5646
5647 #if 0
5648 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5649 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5650 sometimes don't work. */
5651
5652 static Time enter_timestamp;
5653 #endif
5654
5655 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5656 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5657 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5658 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5659
5660 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5661 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5662
5663 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5664
5665 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5666 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5667
5668 static int temp_index;
5669 static short temp_buffer[100];
5670
5671 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5672 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5673 temp_index = 0; \
5674 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5675
5676 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5677 on a particular display. */
5678
5679 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5680
5681 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5682 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5683 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5684 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5685
5686 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5687
5688 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5689 do \
5690 { \
5691 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5692 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5693 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5694 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5695 inev.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5696 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f); \
5697 } \
5698 while (0)
5699
5700 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5701 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5702
5703
5704 enum
5705 {
5706 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5707 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5708 X_EVENT_DROP
5709 };
5710
5711 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5712 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5713 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5714
5715 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5716 this event further.
5717 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5718
5719 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5720 static int
5721 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5722 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5723 XEvent *event;
5724 {
5725 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5726 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5727 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5728 was created. */
5729
5730 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5731 event->xclient.window);
5732
5733 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5734 }
5735 #endif
5736
5737 #ifdef USE_GTK
5738 static int current_count;
5739 static int current_finish;
5740 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5741
5742 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5743 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5744 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5745 static GdkFilterReturn
5746 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5747 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5748 GdkEvent *ev;
5749 gpointer data;
5750 {
5751 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5752
5753 if (current_count >= 0)
5754 {
5755 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5756
5757 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5758
5759 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5760 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5761 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5762 so we do it here. */
5763 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5764 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5765 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5766 #endif
5767
5768 if (! dpyinfo)
5769 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5770 else
5771 {
5772 current_count +=
5773 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5774 current_hold_quit);
5775 }
5776 }
5777 else
5778 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5779
5780 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5781 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5782
5783 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5784 }
5785 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5786
5787
5788 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5789
5790 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5791 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5792 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5793
5794 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5795
5796 static int
5797 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5798 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5799 XEvent *eventp;
5800 int *finish;
5801 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5802 {
5803 struct input_event inev;
5804 int count = 0;
5805 int do_help = 0;
5806 int nbytes = 0;
5807 struct frame *f;
5808 struct coding_system coding;
5809 XEvent event = *eventp;
5810
5811 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5812
5813 EVENT_INIT (inev);
5814 inev.kind = NO_EVENT;
5815 inev.arg = Qnil;
5816
5817 switch (event.type)
5818 {
5819 case ClientMessage:
5820 {
5821 if (event.xclient.message_type
5822 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5823 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5824 {
5825 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5826 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5827 {
5828 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5829 could be the shell widget window
5830 if the frame has no title bar. */
5831 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5832 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5833 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5834 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5835 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5836 #endif
5837 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5838 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5839 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5840 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5841 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5842 needed.
5843
5844 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5845 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5846 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5847 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5848 Emacs. */
5849
5850 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5851 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5852 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5853 if (f)
5854 {
5855 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5856 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5857 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5858 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5859 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5860 /* The ICCCM says this is
5861 the only valid choice. */
5862 RevertToParent,
5863 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5864 /* This is needed to detect the error
5865 if there is an error. */
5866 XSync (d, False);
5867 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5868 }
5869 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5870 #endif /* 0 */
5871 goto done;
5872 }
5873
5874 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5875 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5876 {
5877 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5878 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5879 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5880 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5881 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5882 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5883 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5884 session manager and one for this. */
5885 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5886 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5887 #endif
5888 {
5889 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5890 event.xclient.window);
5891 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5892 for a single Emacs process. */
5893 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5894 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5895 event.xclient.window,
5896 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5897 else if (f)
5898 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5899 event.xclient.window,
5900 0, 0);
5901 }
5902 goto done;
5903 }
5904
5905 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5906 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5907 {
5908 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5909 event.xclient.window);
5910 if (!f)
5911 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5912
5913 inev.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5914 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
5915 goto done;
5916 }
5917
5918 goto done;
5919 }
5920
5921 if (event.xclient.message_type
5922 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5923 {
5924 goto done;
5925 }
5926
5927 if (event.xclient.message_type
5928 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5929 {
5930 int new_x, new_y;
5931 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5932
5933 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5934 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5935
5936 if (f)
5937 {
5938 f->left_pos = new_x;
5939 f->top_pos = new_y;
5940 }
5941 goto done;
5942 }
5943
5944 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5945 if (event.xclient.message_type
5946 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5947 {
5948 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5949 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5950 &event, NULL);
5951 goto done;
5952 }
5953 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5954
5955 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5956 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5957 || (event.xclient.message_type
5958 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5959 {
5960 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5961 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5962 currently never do because we are interested in
5963 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5964 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5965 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5966 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5967 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5968 goto done;
5969 }
5970
5971 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5972 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5973 we construct an input_event. */
5974 if (event.xclient.message_type
5975 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5976 {
5977 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev);
5978 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5979 goto done;
5980 }
5981 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5982
5983 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5984
5985 if (!f)
5986 goto OTHER;
5987
5988 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev))
5989 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5990 }
5991 break;
5992
5993 case SelectionNotify:
5994 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5995 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5996 goto OTHER;
5997 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5998 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5999 break;
6000
6001 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6002 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6003 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6004 goto OTHER;
6005 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6006 {
6007 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6008
6009 inev.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6010 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
6011 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
6012 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
6013 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6014 }
6015 break;
6016
6017 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6018 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6019 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6020 goto OTHER;
6021 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6022 if (x_queue_selection_requests)
6023 x_queue_event (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner),
6024 &event);
6025 else
6026 {
6027 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6028 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6029
6030 inev.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6031 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
6032 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev) = eventp->requestor;
6033 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
6034 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev) = eventp->target;
6035 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev) = eventp->property;
6036 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
6037 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6038 }
6039 break;
6040
6041 case PropertyNotify:
6042 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
6043 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
6044 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
6045 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
6046 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
6047 goto OTHER;
6048 #endif
6049 #endif
6050 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6051 goto OTHER;
6052
6053 case ReparentNotify:
6054 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6055 if (f)
6056 {
6057 int x, y;
6058 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6059 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6060 f->left_pos = x;
6061 f->top_pos = y;
6062
6063 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6064 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6065 }
6066 goto OTHER;
6067
6068 case Expose:
6069 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6070 if (f)
6071 {
6072 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6073
6074 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6075 {
6076 f->async_visible = 1;
6077 f->async_iconified = 0;
6078 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6079 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6080 }
6081 else
6082 expose_frame (f,
6083 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6084 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6085 }
6086 else
6087 {
6088 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6089 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6090 #endif
6091 #if defined USE_LUCID
6092 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6093 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6094 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6095 {
6096 Widget widget
6097 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6098 if (widget)
6099 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6100 }
6101 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6102
6103 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6104 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6105 goto OTHER;
6106 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6107 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6108 event.xexpose.window);
6109
6110 if (bar)
6111 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6112 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6113 else
6114 goto OTHER;
6115 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6116 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6117 }
6118 break;
6119
6120 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6121 source area was obscured or not
6122 available. */
6123 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6124 if (f)
6125 {
6126 expose_frame (f,
6127 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6128 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6129 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6130 }
6131 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6132 else
6133 goto OTHER;
6134 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6135 break;
6136
6137 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6138 source area was completely
6139 available. */
6140 break;
6141
6142 case UnmapNotify:
6143 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6144 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6145 {
6146 tip_window = 0;
6147 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6148 }
6149
6150 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6151 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6152 the frame was deleted. */
6153 {
6154 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6155 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6156 display that won't ever be seen. */
6157 f->async_visible = 0;
6158 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6159 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6160 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6161 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6162 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6163 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6164 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6165 {
6166 f->async_iconified = 1;
6167
6168 inev.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6169 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6170 }
6171 }
6172 goto OTHER;
6173
6174 case MapNotify:
6175 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6176 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6177 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6178 goto OTHER;
6179
6180 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6181 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6182 frame is visible. */
6183 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6184 if (f)
6185 {
6186 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6187 the frame's display structures.
6188 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6189 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6190 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6191 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6192 if (! f->async_iconified)
6193 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6194
6195 f->async_visible = 1;
6196 f->async_iconified = 0;
6197 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6198
6199 if (f->iconified)
6200 {
6201 inev.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6202 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6203 }
6204 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6205 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6206 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6207 to update the frame titles
6208 in case this is the second frame. */
6209 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6210 }
6211 goto OTHER;
6212
6213 case KeyPress:
6214
6215 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6216
6217 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6218 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6219 if (popup_activated ())
6220 goto OTHER;
6221 #endif
6222
6223 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6224
6225 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6226 {
6227 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6228 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6229 }
6230
6231 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6232 if (f == 0)
6233 {
6234 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6235 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6236 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6237 event.xkey.window);
6238 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6239 {
6240 widget = XtParent (widget);
6241 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6242 }
6243 }
6244 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6245
6246 if (f != 0)
6247 {
6248 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6249 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6250 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6251 his Emacs hang.
6252
6253 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6254 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6255 status_return even if the input is too long to
6256 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6257 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6258 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6259 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6260 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6261 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6262 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6263 int modifiers;
6264 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6265 Lisp_Object c;
6266
6267 #ifdef USE_GTK
6268 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6269 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6270 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6271 (see above). */
6272 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6273 #endif
6274
6275 event.xkey.state
6276 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6277 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6278 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6279
6280 /* This will have to go some day... */
6281
6282 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6283 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6284 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6285 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6286 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6287 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6288 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6289
6290 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6291 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6292 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6293 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6294 not it is combined with Meta. */
6295 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6296 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6297
6298 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6299 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6300 {
6301 Status status_return;
6302
6303 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6304 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6305 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6306 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6307 &status_return);
6308 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6309 {
6310 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6311 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6312 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6313 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6314 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6315 &status_return);
6316 }
6317 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6318 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6319 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6320 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6321 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6322 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6323 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6324 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6325 &status_return);
6326 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6327 {
6328 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6329 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6330 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6331 &event.xkey,
6332 copy_bufptr,
6333 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6334 &status_return);
6335 }
6336 }
6337 #endif
6338
6339 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6340 break;
6341 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6342 {
6343 keysym = NoSymbol;
6344 modifiers = 0;
6345 }
6346 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6347 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6348 abort ();
6349 }
6350 else
6351 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6352 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6353 &compose_status);
6354 #else
6355 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6356 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6357 &compose_status);
6358 #endif
6359
6360 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6361 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6362 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6363 break;
6364
6365 orig_keysym = keysym;
6366
6367 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6368 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6369 inev.modifiers
6370 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6371 inev.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6372
6373 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6374 translations to characters. */
6375 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6376 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6377 {
6378 inev.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6379 inev.code = keysym;
6380 goto done_keysym;
6381 }
6382
6383 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6384 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6385 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6386 Vx_keysym_table,
6387 Qnil))))
6388 {
6389 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6390 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6391 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6392 inev.code = XFASTINT (c);
6393 goto done_keysym;
6394 }
6395
6396 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6397 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6398 || keysym == XK_Delete
6399 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6400 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6401 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6402 #endif
6403 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6404 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6405 #ifdef HPUX
6406 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6407 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6408 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6409 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6410 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6411 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6412 #endif
6413 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6414 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6415 #endif
6416 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6417 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6418 #endif
6419 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6420 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6421 #endif
6422 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6423 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6424 #endif
6425 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6426 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6427 #endif
6428 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6429 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6430 #endif
6431 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6432 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6433 #endif
6434 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6435 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6436 #endif
6437 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6438 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6439 #endif
6440 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6441 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6442 #endif
6443 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6444 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6445 #endif
6446 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6447 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6448 #endif
6449 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6450 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6451 #endif
6452 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6453 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6454 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6455 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6456 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6457 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6458 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6459 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6460 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6461 #endif
6462 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6463 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6464 #endif
6465 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6466 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6467 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6468 don't have real modifiers but
6469 should be treated similarly to
6470 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6471 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6472 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6473 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6474 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6475 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6476 #endif
6477 ))
6478 {
6479 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6480 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6481 key. */
6482 inev.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6483 inev.code = keysym;
6484 goto done_keysym;
6485 }
6486
6487 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6488 register int i;
6489 register int c;
6490 int nchars, len;
6491
6492 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6493 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6494 we used just above and the locale. */
6495 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6496 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6497 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6498 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6499 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6500 gives us composition information. */
6501 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6502
6503 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6504 {
6505 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6506 }
6507
6508 {
6509 /* Decode the input data. */
6510 int require;
6511 unsigned char *p;
6512
6513 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6514 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6515 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6516 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6517 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6518 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6519 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6520 nbytes = coding.produced;
6521 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6522 copy_bufptr = p;
6523 }
6524
6525 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6526 character events. */
6527 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6528 {
6529 if (nchars == nbytes)
6530 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6531 else
6532 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6533 nbytes - i, len);
6534 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6535 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6536 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6537 inev.code = c;
6538 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6539 }
6540
6541 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6542 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6543 count += nbytes;
6544
6545 inev.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6546
6547 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6548 break;
6549 }
6550 }
6551 done_keysym:
6552 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6553 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6554 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6555 client. */
6556 break;
6557 #else
6558 goto OTHER;
6559 #endif
6560
6561 case KeyRelease:
6562 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6563 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6564 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6565 client. */
6566 break;
6567 #else
6568 goto OTHER;
6569 #endif
6570
6571 case EnterNotify:
6572 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6573
6574 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6575
6576 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6577 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6578
6579 #if 0
6580 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6581 {
6582 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6583 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6584 || !(f->auto_lower)
6585 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6586 {
6587 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6588 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6589 }
6590 }
6591 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6592 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6593 #endif
6594
6595 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6596 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6597 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6598 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6599 goto OTHER;
6600
6601 case FocusIn:
6602 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6603 goto OTHER;
6604
6605 case LeaveNotify:
6606 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6607
6608 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6609 if (f)
6610 {
6611 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6612 {
6613 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6614 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6615 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6616 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6617 }
6618
6619 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6620 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6621 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6622 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6623 if (any_help_event_p)
6624 do_help = -1;
6625 }
6626 goto OTHER;
6627
6628 case FocusOut:
6629 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6630 goto OTHER;
6631
6632 case MotionNotify:
6633 {
6634 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6635 help_echo_string = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
6636 help_echo_pos = -1;
6637
6638 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6639 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6640 f = last_mouse_frame;
6641 else
6642 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6643
6644 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6645 {
6646 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6647 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6648 }
6649
6650 if (f)
6651 {
6652
6653 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6654 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6655 {
6656 Lisp_Object window;
6657
6658 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6659 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6660 0, 0, 0, 0);
6661
6662 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6663 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6664 will be selected iff it is active. */
6665 if (WINDOWP (window)
6666 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6667 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6668 {
6669 inev.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6670 inev.frame_or_window = window;
6671 }
6672
6673 last_window=window;
6674 }
6675 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6676 }
6677 else
6678 {
6679 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6680 struct scroll_bar *bar
6681 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6682 event.xmotion.window);
6683
6684 if (bar)
6685 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6686 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6687
6688 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6689 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6690 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6691 }
6692
6693 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6694 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6695 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6696 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6697 do_help = 1;
6698 goto OTHER;
6699 }
6700
6701 case ConfigureNotify:
6702 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6703 if (f)
6704 {
6705 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6706 #ifdef USE_GTK
6707 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6708 event.xconfigure.height);
6709 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6710 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6711 do this one, the right one will come later.
6712 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6713 need to reset it below. */
6714 int dont_resize
6715 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6716 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6717 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6718 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6719
6720 if (dont_resize)
6721 goto OTHER;
6722
6723 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6724 is called by the code that handles resizing
6725 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6726
6727 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6728 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6729 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6730 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6731 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6732 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6733 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6734 {
6735 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6736 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6737 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6738 }
6739 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6740 #endif
6741
6742 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6743 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6744
6745 #ifdef USE_GTK
6746 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6747 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6748 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6749 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6750 #endif
6751 {
6752 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6753 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6754 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6755
6756 x_check_expected_move (f);
6757 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6758 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6759 }
6760
6761 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6762 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6763 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6764 #endif
6765
6766 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6767 {
6768 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6769 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6770 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6771 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6772 }
6773 }
6774 goto OTHER;
6775
6776 case ButtonRelease:
6777 case ButtonPress:
6778 {
6779 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6780 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6781 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6782
6783 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6784
6785 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6786 && last_mouse_frame
6787 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6788 f = last_mouse_frame;
6789 else
6790 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6791
6792 if (f)
6793 {
6794 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6795 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6796 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6797 {
6798 Lisp_Object window;
6799 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6800 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6801
6802 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6803 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6804 {
6805 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6806 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6807 else
6808 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6809 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6810 event.xbutton.state));
6811 tool_bar_p = 1;
6812 }
6813 }
6814
6815 if (!tool_bar_p)
6816 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6817 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6818 {
6819 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6820 if (! popup_activated ())
6821 #endif
6822 {
6823 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6824 {
6825 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6826 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6827 {
6828 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6829 construct_mouse_click (&inev, &event, f);
6830 }
6831 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6832 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6833 }
6834 else
6835 construct_mouse_click (&inev, &event, f);
6836 }
6837 }
6838 }
6839 else
6840 {
6841 struct scroll_bar *bar
6842 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6843 event.xbutton.window);
6844
6845 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6846 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6847 scroll bars. */
6848 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6849 {
6850 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6851 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6852 }
6853 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6854 if (bar)
6855 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6856 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6857 }
6858
6859 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6860 {
6861 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6862 last_mouse_frame = f;
6863 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
6864 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
6865 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
6866 the ButtonPress. */
6867 if (f != 0)
6868 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6869
6870 if (!tool_bar_p)
6871 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6872 }
6873 else
6874 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6875
6876 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6877 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6878 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6879 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6880 Instead, save it away
6881 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6882 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6883 if (
6884 #ifdef USE_GTK
6885 ! popup_activated ()
6886 &&
6887 #endif
6888 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6889 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6890 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6891 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6892 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6893 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6894 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6895 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6896 {
6897 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6898 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6899 #ifdef USE_GTK
6900 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6901 #endif
6902 }
6903 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6904 {
6905 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6906 goto OTHER;
6907 }
6908
6909 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6910 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6911 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6912 {
6913 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6914 {
6915 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6916 if (f->output_data.x)
6917 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6918 }
6919 else
6920 goto OTHER;
6921 }
6922 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6923 else
6924 goto OTHER;
6925 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6926 }
6927 break;
6928
6929 case CirculateNotify:
6930 goto OTHER;
6931
6932 case CirculateRequest:
6933 goto OTHER;
6934
6935 case VisibilityNotify:
6936 goto OTHER;
6937
6938 case MappingNotify:
6939 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6940 local cache. */
6941 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6942 {
6943 case MappingModifier:
6944 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6945 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6946 case MappingKeyboard:
6947 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6948 }
6949 goto OTHER;
6950
6951 default:
6952 OTHER:
6953 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6954 BLOCK_INPUT;
6955 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6956 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6957 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6958 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6959 break;
6960 }
6961
6962 done:
6963 if (inev.kind != NO_EVENT)
6964 {
6965 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6966 count++;
6967 }
6968
6969 if (do_help
6970 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6971 {
6972 Lisp_Object frame;
6973
6974 if (f)
6975 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6976 else
6977 frame = Qnil;
6978
6979 if (do_help > 0)
6980 {
6981 any_help_event_p = 1;
6982 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6983 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6984 }
6985 else
6986 {
6987 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6988 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6989 }
6990 count++;
6991 }
6992
6993 *eventp = event;
6994 return count;
6995 }
6996
6997
6998 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6999 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7000 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7001
7002 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7003 int
7004 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
7005 XEvent *event;
7006 Display *display;
7007 {
7008 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7009 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7010
7011 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7012
7013 if (dpyinfo)
7014 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7015
7016 return finish;
7017 }
7018
7019
7020 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7021 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7022 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7023
7024 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7025 thus pretending to be `read'.
7026
7027 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7028
7029 static int
7030 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
7031 register int sd;
7032 int expected;
7033 struct input_event *hold_quit;
7034 {
7035 int count = 0;
7036 XEvent event;
7037 int event_found = 0;
7038 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7039
7040 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7041 {
7042 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7043 return -1;
7044 }
7045
7046 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7047 BLOCK_INPUT;
7048
7049 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7050 input_signal_count++;
7051
7052 ++handling_signal;
7053
7054 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
7055 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
7056 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
7057 {
7058 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
7059 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
7060 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
7061 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
7062 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7063 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7064 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7065 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7066 #endif
7067
7068 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7069 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7070 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7071 for X connections. */
7072 #ifndef SIGIO
7073 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7074 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7075 {
7076 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7077 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7078 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7079 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7080 }
7081 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7082 #endif /* SIGIO */
7083 #endif
7084
7085 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7086 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7087 {
7088 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7089 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7090 }
7091
7092 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7093 {
7094 struct input_event inev;
7095 BLOCK_INPUT;
7096 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7097 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7098 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7099 {
7100 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7101 count++;
7102 }
7103 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7104 }
7105 #endif
7106
7107 #ifndef USE_GTK
7108 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7109 {
7110 int finish;
7111
7112 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7113
7114 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7115 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7116 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7117 break;
7118 #endif
7119 event_found = 1;
7120
7121 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7122
7123 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7124 goto out;
7125 }
7126 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7127 }
7128
7129 #ifdef USE_GTK
7130
7131 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7132 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7133 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7134 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7135
7136 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7137 from all displays. */
7138
7139 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7140 {
7141 current_count = count;
7142 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7143
7144 gtk_main_iteration ();
7145
7146 count = current_count;
7147 current_count = -1;
7148 current_hold_quit = 0;
7149
7150 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7151 break;
7152 }
7153 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7154
7155 out:;
7156
7157 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7158 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7159 if (! event_found)
7160 {
7161 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7162 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7163 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7164 x_noop_count++;
7165 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7166 {
7167 x_noop_count=0;
7168
7169 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7170 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7171
7172 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7173
7174 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7175 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7176 }
7177 }
7178
7179 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7180 raise it now. */
7181 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7182 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7183 {
7184 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7185 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7186 }
7187
7188 --handling_signal;
7189 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7190
7191 return count;
7192 }
7193
7194
7195
7196 \f
7197 /***********************************************************************
7198 Text Cursor
7199 ***********************************************************************/
7200
7201 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7202 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7203
7204 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7205 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7206 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7207
7208 static void
7209 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc)
7210 struct window *w;
7211 struct glyph_row *row;
7212 GC gc;
7213 {
7214 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7215 XRectangle clip_rect;
7216 int window_y, window_width;
7217
7218 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7219
7220 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
7221 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
7222 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7223 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7224 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7225
7226 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7227 }
7228
7229
7230 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7231
7232 static void
7233 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7234 struct window *w;
7235 struct glyph_row *row;
7236 {
7237 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7238 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7239 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7240 int x, y, wd, h;
7241 XGCValues xgcv;
7242 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7243 GC gc;
7244
7245 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7246 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7247 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7248 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7249 return;
7250
7251 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
7252 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
7253 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
7254 width instead. */
7255 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
7256 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
7257 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
7258 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
7259 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
7260
7261 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
7262 coordinates. */
7263 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7264 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y);
7265
7266 /* Compute the proper height and ascent of the rectangle, based
7267 on the actual glyph. Using the full height of the row looks
7268 bad when there are tall images on that row. */
7269 h = max (min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->height),
7270 cursor_glyph->ascent + cursor_glyph->descent);
7271 if (h < row->height)
7272 y += row->ascent /* - w->phys_cursor_ascent */ + cursor_glyph->descent - h;
7273 h--;
7274
7275 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7276 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7277 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7278 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7279 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7280 else
7281 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7282 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7283 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7284
7285 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7286 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7287 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7288 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7289 }
7290
7291
7292 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7293
7294 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7295 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7296 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7297 --gerd. */
7298
7299 static void
7300 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7301 struct window *w;
7302 struct glyph_row *row;
7303 int width;
7304 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7305 {
7306 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7307 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7308
7309 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7310 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7311 and mini-buffer. */
7312 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7313 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7314 return;
7315
7316 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7317 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7318 the bar might not be in the window. */
7319 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7320 {
7321 struct glyph_row *row;
7322 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7323 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7324 }
7325 else
7326 {
7327 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7328 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7329 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7330 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7331 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7332 XGCValues xgcv;
7333
7334 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7335 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7336 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7337 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7338 that the glyph is legible. */
7339 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7340 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7341 else
7342 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7343 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7344
7345 if (gc)
7346 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7347 else
7348 {
7349 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7350 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7351 }
7352
7353 if (width < 0)
7354 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7355 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7356
7357 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7358 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7359
7360 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7361 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7362 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7363 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7364 width, row->height);
7365 else
7366 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7367 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7368 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7369 row->height - width),
7370 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7371 width);
7372
7373 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7374 }
7375 }
7376
7377
7378 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7379
7380 static void
7381 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7382 struct frame *f;
7383 Cursor cursor;
7384 {
7385 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7386 }
7387
7388
7389 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7390
7391 static void
7392 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7393 struct frame *f;
7394 int x, y, width, height;
7395 {
7396 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7397 x, y, width, height, False);
7398 }
7399
7400
7401 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7402
7403 static void
7404 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7405 struct window *w;
7406 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7407 int x, y;
7408 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7409 int on_p, active_p;
7410 {
7411 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7412
7413 if (on_p)
7414 {
7415 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7416 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7417
7418 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7419 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7420 {
7421 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7422 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7423 }
7424 else
7425 switch (cursor_type)
7426 {
7427 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7428 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7429 break;
7430
7431 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7432 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7433 break;
7434
7435 case BAR_CURSOR:
7436 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7437 break;
7438
7439 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7440 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7441 break;
7442
7443 case NO_CURSOR:
7444 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7445 break;
7446
7447 default:
7448 abort ();
7449 }
7450
7451 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7452 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7453 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7454 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7455 #endif
7456 }
7457
7458 #ifndef XFlush
7459 if (updating_frame != f)
7460 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7461 #endif
7462 }
7463
7464 \f
7465 /* Icons. */
7466
7467 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7468
7469 int
7470 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7471 struct frame *f;
7472 Lisp_Object file;
7473 {
7474 int bitmap_id;
7475
7476 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7477 return 1;
7478
7479 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7480 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7481 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7482 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7483
7484 if (STRINGP (file))
7485 {
7486 #ifdef USE_GTK
7487 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7488 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7489 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7490 return 0;
7491 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7492 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7493 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7494 }
7495 else
7496 {
7497 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7498 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7499 {
7500 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7501 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7502 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7503 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7504 }
7505
7506 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7507 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7508 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7509 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7510 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7511
7512 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7513 }
7514
7515 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7516 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7517
7518 return 0;
7519 }
7520
7521
7522 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7523 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7524
7525 int
7526 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7527 struct frame *f;
7528 char *icon_name;
7529 {
7530 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7531 return 1;
7532
7533 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7534 {
7535 XTextProperty text;
7536 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7537 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7538 text.format = 8;
7539 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7540 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7541 }
7542 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7543 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7544 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7545
7546 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7547 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7548 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7549 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7550
7551 return 0;
7552 }
7553 \f
7554 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7555
7556 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7557 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7558
7559 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7560
7561 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7562 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7563 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7564
7565 static void
7566 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7567 Display *display;
7568 XErrorEvent *error;
7569 {
7570 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7571 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7572 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7573 }
7574
7575 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7576 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7577 operating on.
7578
7579 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7580 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7581 stored in x_error_message_string.
7582
7583 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7584 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7585
7586 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7587
7588 void x_check_errors ();
7589 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7590
7591 int
7592 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7593 Display *dpy;
7594 {
7595 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7596
7597 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7598 XSync (dpy, False);
7599
7600 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7601 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7602 x_error_message_string));
7603
7604 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7605 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7606
7607 return count;
7608 }
7609
7610 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7611
7612 static Lisp_Object
7613 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7614 Lisp_Object old_val;
7615 {
7616 Lisp_Object first = XCAR (old_val);
7617 Display *dpy = XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer;
7618
7619 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7620 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7621 if (x_display_info_for_display (dpy) != 0)
7622 XSync (dpy, False);
7623
7624 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7625 return Qnil;
7626 }
7627
7628 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7629 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7630 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7631
7632 void
7633 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7634 Display *dpy;
7635 char *format;
7636 {
7637 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7638 XSync (dpy, False);
7639
7640 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7641 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7642 }
7643
7644 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7645 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7646
7647 int
7648 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7649 Display *dpy;
7650 {
7651 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7652 XSync (dpy, False);
7653
7654 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7655 }
7656
7657 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7658
7659 void
7660 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7661 Display *dpy;
7662 {
7663 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7664 }
7665
7666 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7667 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7668 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7669 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7670
7671 void
7672 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7673 Display *dpy;
7674 int count;
7675 {
7676 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7677 }
7678
7679 #if 0
7680 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7681 x_trace_wire ()
7682 {
7683 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7684 }
7685 #endif /* ! 0 */
7686
7687 \f
7688 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7689 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7690 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7691 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7692 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7693
7694 static SIGTYPE
7695 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7696 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7697 {
7698 #ifdef USG
7699 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7700 must reestablish each time */
7701 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7702 #endif /* USG */
7703 }
7704
7705 \f
7706 /************************************************************************
7707 Handling X errors
7708 ************************************************************************/
7709
7710 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7711
7712 static char *error_msg;
7713
7714 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7715 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7716 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7717
7718 static void
7719 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7720 {
7721 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7722 exit (70);
7723 }
7724
7725 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7726 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7727
7728 static SIGTYPE
7729 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7730 Display *dpy;
7731 char *error_message;
7732 {
7733 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7734 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7735 int count;
7736
7737 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7738 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7739 handling_signal = 0;
7740
7741 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7742 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7743 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7744 the original message here. */
7745 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7746
7747 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7748 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7749 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7750
7751 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7752 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7753 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7754
7755 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7756 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7757
7758 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7759 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7760 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7761
7762 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7763 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7764 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7765 if (dpyinfo)
7766 {
7767 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7768 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7769 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7770 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7771 }
7772 #endif
7773
7774 #ifdef USE_GTK
7775 if (dpyinfo)
7776 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7777 #endif
7778
7779 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7780 if (dpyinfo)
7781 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7782
7783 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7784 that are on the dead display. */
7785 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7786 {
7787 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7788 minibuf_frame
7789 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7790 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7791 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7792 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7793 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7794 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7795 }
7796
7797 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7798 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7799 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7800 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7801 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7802 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7803 {
7804 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7805 trying to find a replacement. */
7806 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7807 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7808 }
7809
7810 if (dpyinfo)
7811 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7812
7813 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7814
7815 if (x_display_list == 0)
7816 {
7817 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7818 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7819 exit (70);
7820 }
7821
7822 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7823 #ifdef SIGIO
7824 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7825 #endif
7826 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7827 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7828
7829 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7830 error ("%s", error_msg);
7831 }
7832
7833
7834 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7835 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7836 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7837
7838 static void
7839 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7840 Display *display;
7841 XErrorEvent *error;
7842 {
7843 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7844
7845 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7846 original error handler. */
7847
7848 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7849 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7850 buf, error->request_code);
7851 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7852 }
7853
7854
7855 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7856 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7857
7858 static int
7859 x_error_handler (display, error)
7860 Display *display;
7861 XErrorEvent *error;
7862 {
7863 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7864 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7865 else
7866 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7867 return 0;
7868 }
7869
7870 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7871 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7872 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7873
7874 static int
7875 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7876 Display *display;
7877 {
7878 char buf[256];
7879
7880 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7881 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7882 return 0;
7883 }
7884 \f
7885 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7886
7887 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7888 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7889 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7890 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7891
7892 Lisp_Object
7893 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7894 struct frame *f;
7895 register char *fontname;
7896 {
7897 struct font_info *fontp
7898 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7899
7900 if (!fontp)
7901 return Qnil;
7902
7903 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7904 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7905 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7906
7907 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (f));
7908 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7909
7910 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7911
7912 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7913 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7914 {
7915 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7916 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7917 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7918 }
7919 else
7920 {
7921 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7922 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7923 }
7924
7925 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7926 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7927 {
7928 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7929 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7930 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7931 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7932 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7933 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7934
7935 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7936 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7937 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7938 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7939 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7940 }
7941
7942 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7943 }
7944
7945 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7946 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7947 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7948 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7949
7950 Lisp_Object
7951 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7952 struct frame *f;
7953 char *fontsetname;
7954 {
7955 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7956 Lisp_Object result;
7957
7958 if (fontset < 0)
7959 return Qnil;
7960
7961 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7962 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7963 to do. */
7964 return fontset_name (fontset);
7965
7966 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7967
7968 if (!STRINGP (result))
7969 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7970 return Qnil;
7971
7972 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7973 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7974
7975 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7976 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7977 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7978 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7979 #endif
7980
7981 return build_string (fontsetname);
7982 }
7983
7984 \f
7985 /***********************************************************************
7986 X Input Methods
7987 ***********************************************************************/
7988
7989 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7990
7991 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7992
7993 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7994 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7995 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7996
7997 static void
7998 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7999 XIM xim;
8000 XPointer client_data;
8001 XPointer call_data;
8002 {
8003 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8004 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8005
8006 BLOCK_INPUT;
8007
8008 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8009 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8010 {
8011 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8012 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8013 {
8014 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8015 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8016 }
8017 }
8018
8019 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8020 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8021 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8022 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8023 }
8024
8025 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8026
8027 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8028 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8029 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
8030 #endif
8031
8032 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8033 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8034
8035 static void
8036 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8037 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8038 char *resource_name;
8039 {
8040 XIM xim;
8041
8042 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8043 if (use_xim)
8044 {
8045 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8046 EMACS_CLASS);
8047 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8048
8049 if (xim)
8050 {
8051 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8052 XIMCallback destroy;
8053 #endif
8054
8055 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8056 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8057
8058 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8059 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8060 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8061 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8062 #endif
8063 }
8064 }
8065
8066 else
8067 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8068 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8069 }
8070
8071
8072 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8073
8074 struct xim_inst_t
8075 {
8076 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8077 char *resource_name;
8078 };
8079
8080 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8081 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8082 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8083 when the callback was registered. */
8084
8085 static void
8086 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8087 Display *display;
8088 XPointer client_data;
8089 XPointer call_data;
8090 {
8091 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8092 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8093
8094 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8095 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8096 return;
8097
8098 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8099
8100 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8101 as they have no XIC. */
8102 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8103 {
8104 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8105
8106 BLOCK_INPUT;
8107 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8108 {
8109 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8110
8111 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8112 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8113 {
8114 create_frame_xic (f);
8115 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8116 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8117 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8118 {
8119 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8120 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8121 }
8122 }
8123 }
8124
8125 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8126 }
8127 }
8128
8129 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8130
8131
8132 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8133 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8134 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8135 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8136
8137 static void
8138 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8139 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8140 char *resource_name;
8141 {
8142 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8143 if (use_xim)
8144 {
8145 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8146 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8147 int len;
8148
8149 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8150 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8151 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8152 len = strlen (resource_name);
8153 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8154 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8155 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8156 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8157 xim_instantiate_callback,
8158 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8159 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8160 least, hence the configure test. */
8161 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8162 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8163 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8164 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8165 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8166
8167 }
8168 else
8169 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8170 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8171 }
8172
8173
8174 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8175
8176 static void
8177 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8178 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8179 {
8180 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8181 if (use_xim)
8182 {
8183 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8184 if (dpyinfo->display)
8185 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8186 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8187 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8188 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8189 if (dpyinfo->display)
8190 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8191 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8192 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8193 }
8194 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8195 }
8196
8197 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8198
8199
8200 \f
8201 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8202 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8203
8204 void
8205 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8206 struct frame *f;
8207 {
8208 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
8209 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8210
8211 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8212 is already for the top-left corner. */
8213 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8214 return;
8215
8216 /* Find the offsets of the outside upper-left corner of
8217 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
8218 But do this only if we will need the results. */
8219 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8220 /* This is to get *_pixels_outer_diff. */
8221 x_real_positions (f, &win_x, &win_y);
8222
8223 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8224 position that fits on the screen. */
8225 if (flags & XNegative)
8226 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8227 - 2 * FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->x_pixels_outer_diff
8228 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
8229 + f->left_pos);
8230
8231 {
8232 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8233
8234 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8235 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8236 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8237
8238 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8239 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8240 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8241 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8242 is right, though.
8243
8244 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8245 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8246
8247 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8248 #endif
8249
8250 if (flags & YNegative)
8251 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
8252 - FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->y_pixels_outer_diff
8253
8254 /* Assume the window manager decorations are the same size on
8255 three sides, i.e. left, right and bottom. This is to
8256 compensate for the bottom part. */
8257 - FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->x_pixels_outer_diff
8258 - height
8259 + f->top_pos);
8260 }
8261
8262 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8263 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8264 so the flags should correspond. */
8265 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8266 }
8267
8268 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8269 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8270 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8271 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8272 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8273
8274 void
8275 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8276 struct frame *f;
8277 register int xoff, yoff;
8278 int change_gravity;
8279 {
8280 int modified_top, modified_left;
8281
8282 if (change_gravity > 0)
8283 {
8284 f->top_pos = yoff;
8285 f->left_pos = xoff;
8286 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8287 if (xoff < 0)
8288 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8289 if (yoff < 0)
8290 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8291 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8292 }
8293 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8294
8295 BLOCK_INPUT;
8296 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8297
8298 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8299 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8300
8301 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8302 {
8303 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8304 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8305 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8306 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8307 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8308 }
8309
8310 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8311 modified_left, modified_top);
8312
8313 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8314 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8315 {
8316 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8317 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8318 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8319 }
8320
8321 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8322 }
8323
8324 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8325 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8326 static void
8327 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8328 struct frame *f;
8329 {
8330 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8331 {
8332 int width, height, ign;
8333
8334 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8335
8336 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8337
8338 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8339 when setting WM manager hints.
8340 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8341 x_check_expected_move. */
8342 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8343 {
8344 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8345 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8346 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8347
8348 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8349 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8350 }
8351 }
8352 }
8353
8354 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8355 the window.
8356 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8357 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8358 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8359 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8360 static void
8361 x_check_expected_move (f)
8362 struct frame *f;
8363 {
8364 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8365 {
8366 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8367 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8368
8369 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8370 {
8371 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8372 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8373 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8374
8375 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 1);
8376 }
8377 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8378 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8379
8380 /* Just do this once */
8381 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8382 }
8383 }
8384
8385
8386 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8387 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8388 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8389 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8390
8391 static void
8392 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8393 struct frame *f;
8394 int change_gravity;
8395 int cols, rows;
8396 {
8397 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8398
8399 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8400 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8401 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8402 ? 0
8403 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8404 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8405 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8406
8407 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8408
8409 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8410 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8411
8412 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8413 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8414
8415 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8416 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8417 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8418
8419 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8420 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8421 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8422 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8423
8424 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8425 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8426 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8427 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8428 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8429
8430 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8431 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8432 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8433 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8434 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8435
8436 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8437 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8438 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8439 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8440 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8441
8442 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8443 }
8444
8445
8446 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8447 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8448 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8449 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8450
8451 void
8452 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8453 struct frame *f;
8454 int change_gravity;
8455 int cols, rows;
8456 {
8457 BLOCK_INPUT;
8458
8459 #ifdef USE_GTK
8460 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8461 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8462 else
8463 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8464 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8465
8466 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8467 {
8468 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8469 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8470 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8471 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8472 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8473 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8474 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8475 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8476 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8477 }
8478 else
8479 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8480
8481 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8482
8483 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8484
8485 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8486
8487 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8488 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8489
8490 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8491 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8492 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8493 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8494 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8495
8496 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8497 }
8498 \f
8499 /* Mouse warping. */
8500
8501 void
8502 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8503 struct frame *f;
8504 int x, y;
8505 {
8506 int pix_x, pix_y;
8507
8508 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8509 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8510
8511 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8512 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8513
8514 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8515 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8516
8517 BLOCK_INPUT;
8518
8519 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8520 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8521 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8522 }
8523
8524 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8525
8526 void
8527 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8528 struct frame *f;
8529 int pix_x, pix_y;
8530 {
8531 BLOCK_INPUT;
8532
8533 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8534 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8535 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8536 }
8537 \f
8538 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8539
8540 void
8541 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8542 struct frame *f;
8543 {
8544 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8545 x_raise_frame (f);
8546 #endif
8547 #if 0
8548 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8549 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8550 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8551 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8552 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8553 #endif /* ! 0 */
8554 }
8555
8556 void
8557 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8558 struct frame *f;
8559 {
8560 #if 0
8561 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8562 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8563 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8564 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8565 #endif /* ! 0 */
8566 }
8567
8568 /* Raise frame F. */
8569
8570 void
8571 x_raise_frame (f)
8572 struct frame *f;
8573 {
8574 if (f->async_visible)
8575 {
8576 BLOCK_INPUT;
8577 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8578 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8579 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8580 }
8581 }
8582
8583 /* Lower frame F. */
8584
8585 void
8586 x_lower_frame (f)
8587 struct frame *f;
8588 {
8589 if (f->async_visible)
8590 {
8591 BLOCK_INPUT;
8592 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8593 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8594 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8595 }
8596 }
8597
8598 static void
8599 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8600 FRAME_PTR f;
8601 int raise_flag;
8602 {
8603 if (raise_flag)
8604 x_raise_frame (f);
8605 else
8606 x_lower_frame (f);
8607 }
8608 \f
8609 /* Change of visibility. */
8610
8611 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8612 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8613 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8614 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8615 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8616 finishes with it. */
8617
8618 void
8619 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8620 struct frame *f;
8621 {
8622 Lisp_Object type;
8623 int original_top, original_left;
8624 int retry_count = 2;
8625
8626 retry:
8627
8628 BLOCK_INPUT;
8629
8630 type = x_icon_type (f);
8631 if (!NILP (type))
8632 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8633
8634 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8635 {
8636 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8637 call x_set_offset a second time
8638 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8639 before the window gets really visible. */
8640 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8641 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8642 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8643
8644 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8645
8646 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8647 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8648 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8649 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8650 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8651 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8652 #ifdef USE_GTK
8653 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8654 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8655 #else
8656 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8657 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8658 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8659 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8660 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8661 to come back ok without this. */
8662 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8663 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8664 #endif
8665 }
8666
8667 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8668
8669 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8670 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8671 so that incoming events are handled. */
8672 {
8673 Lisp_Object frame;
8674 int count;
8675 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8676 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8677 will set it when they are handled. */
8678 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8679
8680 original_left = f->left_pos;
8681 original_top = f->top_pos;
8682
8683 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8684 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8685
8686 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8687
8688 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8689 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8690 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8691 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8692
8693 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8694 because the window manager may choose the position
8695 and we don't want to override it. */
8696
8697 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8698 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8699 && previously_visible)
8700 {
8701 Drawable rootw;
8702 int x, y;
8703 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8704
8705 BLOCK_INPUT;
8706
8707 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8708 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8709 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8710 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8711 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8712 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8713 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8714 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8715 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8716
8717 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8718 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8719 original_left, original_top);
8720
8721 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8722 }
8723
8724 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8725
8726 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8727 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8728 MapNotify at all.. */
8729 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8730 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8731 {
8732 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8733 x_sync (f);
8734
8735 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8736 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8737 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8738 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8739 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8740 probably a bug. */
8741 if (input_polling_used ())
8742 {
8743 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8744 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8745 handler reset it. */
8746 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8747 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8748 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8749 poll_for_input_1 ();
8750 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8751 }
8752
8753 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8754 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8755 }
8756
8757 /* 2000-09-28: In
8758
8759 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8760 (iconify-frame f)
8761 (raise-frame f))
8762
8763 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8764 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8765 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8766 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8767
8768 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8769 goto retry;
8770 }
8771 }
8772
8773 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8774
8775 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8776
8777 void
8778 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8779 struct frame *f;
8780 {
8781 Window window;
8782
8783 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8784 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8785
8786 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8787 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8788 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8789
8790 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8791 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8792 return;
8793 #endif
8794
8795 BLOCK_INPUT;
8796
8797 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8798 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8799 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8800 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8801 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8802 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8803
8804 #ifdef USE_GTK
8805 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8806 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8807 else
8808 #endif
8809 {
8810 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8811
8812 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8813 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8814 {
8815 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8816 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8817 }
8818 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8819
8820 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8821 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8822 {
8823 XEvent unmap;
8824
8825 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8826 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8827 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8828 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8829 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8830 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8831 False,
8832 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8833 &unmap))
8834 {
8835 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8836 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8837 }
8838 }
8839
8840 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8841 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8842 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8843 }
8844
8845 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8846 just by the event that we get from the server.
8847 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8848 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8849 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8850 f->visible = 0;
8851 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8852 f->async_visible = 0;
8853 f->async_iconified = 0;
8854
8855 x_sync (f);
8856
8857 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8858 }
8859
8860 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8861
8862 void
8863 x_iconify_frame (f)
8864 struct frame *f;
8865 {
8866 int result;
8867 Lisp_Object type;
8868
8869 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8870 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8871 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8872
8873 if (f->async_iconified)
8874 return;
8875
8876 BLOCK_INPUT;
8877
8878 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8879
8880 type = x_icon_type (f);
8881 if (!NILP (type))
8882 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8883
8884 #ifdef USE_GTK
8885 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8886 {
8887 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8888 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8889
8890 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8891 f->iconified = 1;
8892 f->visible = 1;
8893 f->async_iconified = 1;
8894 f->async_visible = 0;
8895 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8896 return;
8897 }
8898 #endif
8899
8900 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8901
8902 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8903 {
8904 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8905 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8906 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8907 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8908 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8909 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8910 so we have to record it here. */
8911 f->iconified = 1;
8912 f->visible = 1;
8913 f->async_iconified = 1;
8914 f->async_visible = 0;
8915 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8916 return;
8917 }
8918
8919 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8920 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8921 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8922 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8923
8924 if (!result)
8925 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8926
8927 f->async_iconified = 1;
8928 f->async_visible = 0;
8929
8930
8931 BLOCK_INPUT;
8932 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8933 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8934 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8935
8936 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8937 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8938 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8939 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8940
8941 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8942 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8943
8944 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8945 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8946 {
8947 XEvent message;
8948
8949 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8950 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8951 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8952 message.xclient.format = 32;
8953 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8954
8955 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8956 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8957 False,
8958 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8959 &message))
8960 {
8961 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8962 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8963 }
8964 }
8965
8966 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8967 IconicState. */
8968 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8969
8970 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8971 {
8972 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8973 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8974 }
8975
8976 f->async_iconified = 1;
8977 f->async_visible = 0;
8978
8979 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8980 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8981 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8982 }
8983
8984 \f
8985 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8986
8987 void
8988 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8989 struct frame *f;
8990 {
8991 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8992 Lisp_Object bar;
8993 struct scroll_bar *b;
8994
8995 BLOCK_INPUT;
8996
8997 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8998 commands to the X server. */
8999 if (dpyinfo->display)
9000 {
9001 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9002 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9003
9004 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9005 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9006 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9007 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9008 toolkit scroll bars. */
9009 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9010 {
9011 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9012 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9013 }
9014 #endif
9015
9016 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9017 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9018 free_frame_xic (f);
9019 #endif
9020
9021 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9022 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9023 {
9024 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9025 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9026 }
9027 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9028 we are using a toolkit. */
9029 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9030 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9031
9032 free_frame_menubar (f);
9033 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9034
9035 #ifdef USE_GTK
9036 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9037 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9038 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9039 {
9040 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9041 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9042 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9043 }
9044 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9045
9046 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9047 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9048 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9049
9050 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9051 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
9052 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9053 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9054 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9055 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9056
9057 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9058 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9059 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9060 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9061 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9062 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9063 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9064 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9065 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9066 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9067 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9068 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9069 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9070 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9071 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9072
9073 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9074 free_frame_faces (f);
9075
9076 x_free_gcs (f);
9077 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9078 }
9079
9080 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9081 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9082
9083 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9084 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9085
9086 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9087 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9088 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9089 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9090 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9091 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9092
9093 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9094 {
9095 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9096 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9097 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9098 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9099 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9100 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9101 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9102 }
9103
9104 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9105 }
9106
9107
9108 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9109
9110 void
9111 x_destroy_window (f)
9112 struct frame *f;
9113 {
9114 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9115
9116 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9117 commands to the X server. */
9118 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9119 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9120
9121 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9122 }
9123
9124 \f
9125 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9126
9127 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9128 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9129 that the window now has.
9130 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9131 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9132 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9133
9134 #ifndef USE_GTK
9135 void
9136 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9137 struct frame *f;
9138 long flags;
9139 int user_position;
9140 {
9141 XSizeHints size_hints;
9142
9143 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9144 Arg al[2];
9145 int ac = 0;
9146 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9147 #endif
9148
9149 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9150
9151 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9152 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9153
9154 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9155 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9156
9157 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9158 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9159 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9160 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9161 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9162 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9163 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9164 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9165 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9166 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9167
9168 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9169 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9170 size_hints.max_width
9171 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9172 size_hints.max_height
9173 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9174
9175 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9176
9177 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9178 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9179 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9180 {
9181 int base_width, base_height;
9182 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9183
9184 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9185 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9186
9187 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9188
9189 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9190 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9191 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9192 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9193 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9194
9195 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9196 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9197 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9198
9199 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9200 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9201 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9202 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9203 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9204 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9205 #else
9206 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9207 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9208 #endif
9209 }
9210
9211 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9212 if (flags)
9213 {
9214 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9215 goto no_read;
9216 }
9217 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9218
9219 {
9220 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9221 long supplied_return;
9222 int value;
9223
9224 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9225 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9226 &supplied_return);
9227 #else
9228 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9229 #endif
9230
9231 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9232 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9233 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9234 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9235 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9236 #endif
9237
9238 if (flags)
9239 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9240 else
9241 {
9242 if (value == 0)
9243 hints.flags = 0;
9244 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9245 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9246 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9247 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9248 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9249 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9250 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9251 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9252 }
9253 }
9254
9255 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9256 no_read:
9257 #endif
9258
9259 #ifdef PWinGravity
9260 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9261 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9262
9263 if (user_position)
9264 {
9265 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9266 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9267 }
9268 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9269
9270 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9271 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9272 #else
9273 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9274 #endif
9275 }
9276 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9277
9278 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9279
9280 void
9281 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9282 struct frame *f;
9283 int state;
9284 {
9285 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9286 Arg al[1];
9287
9288 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9289 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9290 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9291 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9292
9293 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9294 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9295
9296 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9297 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9298 }
9299
9300 void
9301 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9302 struct frame *f;
9303 int pixmap_id;
9304 {
9305 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9306
9307 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9308 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9309 #endif
9310
9311 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9312 {
9313 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9314 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9315 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9316 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9317 }
9318 else
9319 {
9320 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9321 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9322 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9323 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9324 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9325 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9326 best to explicitly give up. */
9327 #if 0
9328 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9329 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9330 #else
9331 return;
9332 #endif
9333 }
9334
9335 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9336
9337 {
9338 Arg al[1];
9339 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9340 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9341 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9342 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9343 }
9344
9345 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9346
9347 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9348 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9349
9350 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9351 }
9352
9353 void
9354 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9355 struct frame *f;
9356 int icon_x, icon_y;
9357 {
9358 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9359
9360 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9361 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9362 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9363
9364 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9365 }
9366
9367 \f
9368 /***********************************************************************
9369 Fonts
9370 ***********************************************************************/
9371
9372 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9373
9374 struct font_info *
9375 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9376 FRAME_PTR f;
9377 int font_idx;
9378 {
9379 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9380 }
9381
9382
9383 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9384
9385 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9386 to be listed.
9387
9388 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9389
9390 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9391 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9392 on how many fonts to match. */
9393
9394 Lisp_Object
9395 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9396 struct frame *f;
9397 Lisp_Object pattern;
9398 int size;
9399 int maxnames;
9400 {
9401 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9402 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9403 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9404 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9405 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9406 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9407 int count;
9408 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9409
9410 if (size < 0)
9411 {
9412 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9413 size = 0;
9414 }
9415
9416 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9417 if (NILP (patterns))
9418 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9419
9420 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9421 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9422 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9423
9424 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9425 {
9426 int num_fonts;
9427 char **names = NULL;
9428
9429 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9430 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9431 The cache is an alist of the form:
9432 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9433 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9434 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9435 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9436 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9437 if (!NILP (list))
9438 {
9439 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9440 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9441 goto label_cached;
9442 }
9443
9444 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9445
9446 BLOCK_INPUT;
9447 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9448
9449 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9450 {
9451 XFontStruct *font;
9452 unsigned long value;
9453
9454 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9455 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9456 {
9457 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9458 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9459 font = NULL;
9460 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9461 }
9462
9463 if (font
9464 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9465 {
9466 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9467 int len = strlen (name);
9468 char *tmp;
9469
9470 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9471 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9472 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9473 if (len == 0)
9474 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9475 else
9476 {
9477 num_fonts = 1;
9478 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9479 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9480 simple var. */
9481 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9482 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9483 XFree (name);
9484 }
9485 }
9486 else
9487 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9488
9489 if (font)
9490 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9491 }
9492
9493 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9494 {
9495 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9496 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9497 if (maxnames < 0)
9498 {
9499 int limit;
9500
9501 for (limit = 500;;)
9502 {
9503 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9504 if (num_fonts == limit)
9505 {
9506 BLOCK_INPUT;
9507 XFreeFontNames (names);
9508 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9509 limit *= 2;
9510 }
9511 else
9512 break;
9513 }
9514 }
9515 else
9516 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9517 &num_fonts);
9518
9519 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9520 {
9521 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9522 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9523 names = NULL;
9524 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9525 }
9526 }
9527
9528 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9529 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9530
9531 if (names)
9532 {
9533 int i;
9534
9535 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9536 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9537 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9538 {
9539 int width = 0;
9540 char *p = names[i];
9541 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9542
9543 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9544 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9545 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9546 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9547 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9548 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9549 while (*p)
9550 if (*p++ == '-')
9551 {
9552 dashes++;
9553 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9554 width = atoi (p);
9555 else if (dashes == 9)
9556 resx = atoi (p);
9557 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9558 average_width = atoi (p);
9559 }
9560
9561 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9562 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9563 {
9564 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9565 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9566 {
9567 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9568 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9569 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9570 >= 0))
9571 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9572 width of this font. */
9573 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9574 else
9575 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9576 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9577 }
9578 }
9579 }
9580
9581 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9582 {
9583 BLOCK_INPUT;
9584 XFreeFontNames (names);
9585 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9586 }
9587 }
9588
9589 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9590 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9591 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9592
9593 label_cached:
9594 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9595
9596 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9597 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9598 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9599 {
9600 int found_size;
9601
9602 tem = XCAR (list);
9603
9604 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9605 continue;
9606 if (!size)
9607 {
9608 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9609 continue;
9610 }
9611
9612 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9613 {
9614 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9615 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9616 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9617
9618 BLOCK_INPUT;
9619 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9620 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9621 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9622 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9623 {
9624 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9625 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9626 thisinfo = NULL;
9627 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9628 }
9629 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9630 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9631
9632 if (thisinfo)
9633 {
9634 XSETCDR (tem,
9635 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9636 ? make_number (0)
9637 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9638 BLOCK_INPUT;
9639 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9640 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9641 }
9642 else
9643 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9644 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9645 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9646 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9647 }
9648
9649 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9650 if (found_size == size)
9651 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9652 else if (found_size > 0)
9653 {
9654 if (NILP (second_best))
9655 second_best = tem;
9656 else if (found_size < size)
9657 {
9658 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9659 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9660 second_best = tem;
9661 }
9662 else
9663 {
9664 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9665 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9666 second_best = tem;
9667 }
9668 }
9669 }
9670 if (!NILP (newlist))
9671 break;
9672 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9673 {
9674 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9675 break;
9676 }
9677 }
9678
9679 return newlist;
9680 }
9681
9682
9683 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9684
9685 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9686 font table. */
9687
9688 static void
9689 x_check_font (f, font)
9690 struct frame *f;
9691 XFontStruct *font;
9692 {
9693 int i;
9694 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9695
9696 xassert (font != NULL);
9697
9698 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9699 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9700 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9701 break;
9702
9703 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9704 }
9705
9706 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9707
9708 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9709 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9710 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9711 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9712 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9713
9714 static INLINE void
9715 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9716 XFontStruct *font;
9717 int *w, *h;
9718 {
9719 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9720 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9721
9722 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9723 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9724 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9725 if (*w <= 0)
9726 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9727 }
9728
9729
9730 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9731 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9732 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9733 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9734 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9735
9736 static int
9737 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9738 struct frame *f;
9739 {
9740 int i;
9741 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9742 XFontStruct *font;
9743 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9744 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9745
9746 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9747 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9748
9749 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9750 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9751 {
9752 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9753 int w, h;
9754
9755 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9756 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9757 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9758
9759 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9760 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9761 }
9762
9763 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9764 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9765
9766 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9767 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9768 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9769 }
9770
9771
9772 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9773 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9774 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9775 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9776
9777 struct font_info *
9778 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9779 struct frame *f;
9780 register char *fontname;
9781 int size;
9782 {
9783 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9784 Lisp_Object font_names;
9785 int count;
9786
9787 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9788 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9789 we already have by comparing names. */
9790 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9791
9792 if (!NILP (font_names))
9793 {
9794 Lisp_Object tail;
9795 int i;
9796
9797 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9798 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9799 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9800 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9801 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9802 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9803 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9804 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9805 }
9806
9807 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9808 {
9809 char *full_name;
9810 XFontStruct *font;
9811 struct font_info *fontp;
9812 unsigned long value;
9813 int i;
9814
9815 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9816 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9817 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9818 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9819 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9820 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9821 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9822
9823 BLOCK_INPUT;
9824 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9825 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9826 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9827 {
9828 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9829 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9830 font = NULL;
9831 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9832 }
9833 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9834 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9835 if (!font)
9836 return NULL;
9837
9838 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9839 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9840 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9841 break;
9842
9843 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9844 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9845 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9846 {
9847 int sz;
9848 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9849 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9850 dpyinfo->font_table
9851 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9852 }
9853
9854 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9855 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9856 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9857
9858 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9859 BLOCK_INPUT;
9860 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9861 fontp->font = font;
9862 fontp->font_idx = i;
9863 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9864 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9865
9866 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9867 full_name = 0;
9868 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9869 {
9870 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9871 char *p = name;
9872 int dashes = 0;
9873
9874 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9875 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9876 so don't use it.
9877 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9878 stored in them. */
9879 while (*p)
9880 {
9881 if (*p == '-')
9882 dashes++;
9883 p++;
9884 }
9885
9886 if (dashes >= 13)
9887 {
9888 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9889 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9890 }
9891
9892 XFree (name);
9893 }
9894
9895 if (full_name != 0)
9896 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9897 else
9898 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9899
9900 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9901 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9902
9903 if (NILP (font_names))
9904 {
9905 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9906 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9907 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9908 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9909 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9910 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9911 Qnil);
9912
9913 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9914 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9915 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9916 make_number (fontp->size)),
9917 Qnil)),
9918 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9919 if (full_name)
9920 {
9921 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9922 Qnil);
9923 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9924 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9925 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9926 make_number (fontp->size)),
9927 Qnil)),
9928 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9929 }
9930 }
9931
9932 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9933 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9934 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9935 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9936 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9937 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9938 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9939 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9940 fontp->encoding[1]
9941 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9942 /* 1-byte font */
9943 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9944 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9945 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9946 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9947 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9948 /* 2-byte font */
9949 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9950 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9951 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9952 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9953 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9954 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9955 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9956 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9957 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9958 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9959 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9960 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9961 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9962
9963 fontp->baseline_offset
9964 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9965 ? (long) value : 0);
9966 fontp->relative_compose
9967 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9968 ? (long) value : 0);
9969 fontp->default_ascent
9970 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9971 ? (long) value : 0);
9972
9973 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9974 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9975 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9976 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9977 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9978 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9979 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9980 return fontp;
9981 }
9982 }
9983
9984
9985 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9986 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9987
9988 struct font_info *
9989 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9990 struct frame *f;
9991 register char *fontname;
9992 {
9993 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9994 int i;
9995
9996 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9997 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9998 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9999 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
10000 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10001 return NULL;
10002 }
10003
10004
10005 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
10006 `encoder' of the structure. */
10007
10008 void
10009 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
10010 struct font_info *fontp;
10011 {
10012 Lisp_Object list, elt;
10013
10014 elt = Qnil;
10015 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10016 {
10017 elt = XCAR (list);
10018 if (CONSP (elt)
10019 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
10020 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
10021 >= 0)
10022 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10023 >= 0)))
10024 break;
10025 }
10026
10027 if (! NILP (list))
10028 {
10029 struct ccl_program *ccl
10030 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10031
10032 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10033 xfree (ccl);
10034 else
10035 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10036 }
10037 }
10038
10039
10040 \f
10041 /***********************************************************************
10042 Initialization
10043 ***********************************************************************/
10044
10045 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10046 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10047 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10048 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10049
10050 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10051 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10052 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10053
10054 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10055 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10056 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10057 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10058 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10059 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10060 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10061 };
10062 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10063
10064 static int x_initialized;
10065
10066 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10067 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10068 the screen number from the server number. */
10069 static int
10070 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10071 const char *name1, *name2;
10072 {
10073 int seen_colon = 0;
10074 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10075 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10076 int length_until_period = 0;
10077
10078 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10079 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10080 length_until_period++;
10081
10082 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10083 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10084 name1 += 4;
10085 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10086 name2 += 4;
10087 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10088 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10089 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10090 name1 += system_name_length;
10091 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10092 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10093 name2 += system_name_length;
10094 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10095 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10096 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10097 name1 += length_until_period;
10098 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10099 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10100 name2 += length_until_period;
10101
10102 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10103 {
10104 if (*name1 == ':')
10105 seen_colon++;
10106 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10107 return 1;
10108 }
10109 return (seen_colon
10110 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10111 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10112 }
10113 #endif
10114
10115 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10116 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10117 to 5. */
10118 static void
10119 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10120 unsigned long mask;
10121 int *bits;
10122 int *offset;
10123 {
10124 int nr = 0;
10125 int off = 0;
10126
10127 while (!(mask & 1))
10128 {
10129 off++;
10130 mask >>= 1;
10131 }
10132
10133 while (mask & 1)
10134 {
10135 nr++;
10136 mask >>= 1;
10137 }
10138
10139 *offset = off;
10140 *bits = nr;
10141 }
10142
10143 struct x_display_info *
10144 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10145 Lisp_Object display_name;
10146 char *xrm_option;
10147 char *resource_name;
10148 {
10149 int connection;
10150 Display *dpy;
10151 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10152 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10153
10154 BLOCK_INPUT;
10155
10156 if (!x_initialized)
10157 {
10158 x_initialize ();
10159 ++x_initialized;
10160 }
10161
10162 #ifdef USE_GTK
10163 {
10164 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10165 int argc;
10166 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10167 char **argv2 = argv;
10168 GdkAtom atom;
10169
10170 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10171 {
10172 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10173 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10174 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10175 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10176 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10177 }
10178 else
10179 {
10180 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10181 argv[argc] = 0;
10182
10183 argc = 0;
10184 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10185
10186 if (! NILP (display_name))
10187 {
10188 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10189 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10190 }
10191
10192 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10193 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10194
10195 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10196 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10197 #endif
10198
10199 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10200
10201 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10202 fixup_locale ();
10203 xg_initialize ();
10204
10205 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10206
10207 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10208 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10209
10210 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10211 {
10212 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10213 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10214 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10215
10216 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10217 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10218 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10219
10220 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10221 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10222
10223 UNGCPRO;
10224 }
10225
10226 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10227 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10228 }
10229 }
10230 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10231 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10232 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10233 errors with X11R5:
10234 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10235 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10236 So let's not use it until R6. */
10237 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10238 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10239 #endif
10240
10241 {
10242 int argc = 0;
10243 char *argv[3];
10244
10245 argv[0] = "";
10246 argc = 1;
10247 if (xrm_option)
10248 {
10249 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10250 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10251 }
10252 turn_on_atimers (0);
10253 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10254 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10255 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10256 &argc, argv);
10257 turn_on_atimers (1);
10258
10259 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10260 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10261 fixup_locale ();
10262 #endif
10263 }
10264
10265 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10266 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10267 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10268 #endif
10269 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10270 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10271 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10272
10273 /* Detect failure. */
10274 if (dpy == 0)
10275 {
10276 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10277 return 0;
10278 }
10279
10280 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10281
10282 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10283 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10284
10285 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10286 {
10287 struct x_display_info *share;
10288 Lisp_Object tail;
10289
10290 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10291 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10292 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10293 SDATA (display_name)))
10294 break;
10295 if (share)
10296 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10297 else
10298 {
10299 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10300 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10301 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10302 {
10303 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10304 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10305 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10306 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10307 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10308 BLOCK_INPUT;
10309 }
10310
10311 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10312 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10313 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10314 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10315 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10316 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10317 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10318 }
10319 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10320 }
10321 #endif
10322
10323 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10324 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10325 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10326
10327 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10328 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10329 x_display_name_list);
10330 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10331
10332 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10333
10334 #if 0
10335 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10336 #endif /* ! 0 */
10337
10338 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10339 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10340 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10341 + 2);
10342 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10343 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10344
10345 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10346 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10347
10348 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10349 #ifdef USE_GTK
10350 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10351 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10352 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10353
10354 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10355 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10356
10357 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10358 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10359 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10360 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10361 #else
10362 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10363 #endif
10364 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10365 all versions. */
10366 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10367
10368 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10369 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10370 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10371 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10372 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10373 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10374 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10375 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10376 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10377 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10378 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10379 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10380 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10381 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10382 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10383 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10384 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10385 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10386 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10387 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10388 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10389 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10390 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10391 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10392 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10393 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10394 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10395 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10396 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10397 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10398 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10399 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10400 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10401
10402 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10403 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10404 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10405
10406 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10407 {
10408 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10409 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10410 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10411 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10412 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10413 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10414 }
10415
10416 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10417 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10418 {
10419 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10420 {
10421 Lisp_Object value;
10422 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10423 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10424 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10425 Qnil, Qnil);
10426 if (STRINGP (value)
10427 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10428 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10429 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10430 }
10431 }
10432 else
10433 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10434 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10435
10436 {
10437 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10438 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10439 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10440 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10441 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10442 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10443 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10444 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10445 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10446 }
10447
10448 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10449 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10450 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10451 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10452 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10453 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10454 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10455 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10456 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10457 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10458 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10459 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10460 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10461 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10462 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10463 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10464 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10465 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10466 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10467 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10468 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10469 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10470 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10471 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10472 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10473 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10474 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10475 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10476 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10477 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10478 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10479 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10480 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10481 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10482 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10483 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10484 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10485 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10486 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10487 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10488 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10489 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10490 /* For properties of font. */
10491 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10492 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10493 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10494 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10495 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10496 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10497 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10498 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10499
10500 /* Ghostscript support. */
10501 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10502 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10503
10504 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10505 False);
10506
10507 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10508
10509 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10510 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10511
10512 {
10513 char null_bits[1];
10514
10515 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10516
10517 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10518 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10519 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10520 1);
10521 }
10522
10523 {
10524 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10525 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10526 dpyinfo->gray
10527 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10528 gray_bitmap_bits,
10529 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10530 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10531 }
10532
10533 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10534 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10535 #endif
10536
10537 #ifdef subprocesses
10538 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10539 if (connection != 0)
10540 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10541 #endif
10542
10543 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10544 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10545 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10546 /* stdin is a socket here */
10547 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10548 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10549 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10550 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10551 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10552 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10553
10554 #ifdef SIGIO
10555 if (interrupt_input)
10556 init_sigio (connection);
10557 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10558
10559 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10560 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10561 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10562 so that Xt does not crash. */
10563 {
10564 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10565 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10566 Font font;
10567 int count;
10568
10569 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10570 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10571 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10572 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10573 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10574 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10575 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10576 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10577 abort ();
10578 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10579 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10580 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10581 }
10582 #endif
10583 #endif
10584
10585 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10586 for debugging X code. */
10587 {
10588 Lisp_Object value;
10589 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10590 build_string ("synchronous"),
10591 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10592 Qnil, Qnil);
10593 if (STRINGP (value)
10594 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10595 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10596 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10597 }
10598
10599 {
10600 Lisp_Object value;
10601 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10602 build_string ("useXIM"),
10603 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10604 Qnil, Qnil);
10605 #ifdef USE_XIM
10606 if (STRINGP (value)
10607 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10608 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10609 use_xim = 0;
10610 #else
10611 if (STRINGP (value)
10612 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10613 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10614 use_xim = 1;
10615 #endif
10616 }
10617
10618 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10619 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10620 if (x_initialized == 1)
10621 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10622 #endif
10623
10624 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10625
10626 return dpyinfo;
10627 }
10628 \f
10629 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10630 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10631
10632 void
10633 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10634 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10635 {
10636 int i;
10637
10638 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10639
10640 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10641 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10642 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10643 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10644 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10645 else
10646 {
10647 Lisp_Object tail;
10648
10649 tail = x_display_name_list;
10650 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10651 {
10652 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10653 {
10654 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10655 break;
10656 }
10657 tail = XCDR (tail);
10658 }
10659 }
10660
10661 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10662 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10663
10664 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10665 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10666 else
10667 {
10668 struct x_display_info *tail;
10669
10670 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10671 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10672 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10673 }
10674
10675 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10676 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10677 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10678 #endif
10679 #endif
10680 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10681 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10682 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10683 #endif
10684 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10685 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10686 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10687 #endif
10688
10689 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10690 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10691 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10692 {
10693 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10694 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10695 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10696 }
10697
10698 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10699 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10700
10701 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10702 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10703 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10704 xfree (dpyinfo);
10705 }
10706
10707 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10708
10709 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10710 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10711 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10712 that slows us down. */
10713
10714 static void
10715 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10716 struct atimer *timer;
10717 {
10718 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10719 {
10720 BLOCK_INPUT;
10721 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10722 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10723 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10724 }
10725 }
10726
10727 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10728
10729 \f
10730 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10731
10732 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10733
10734 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10735 {
10736 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10737 x_produce_glyphs,
10738 x_write_glyphs,
10739 x_insert_glyphs,
10740 x_clear_end_of_line,
10741 x_scroll_run,
10742 x_after_update_window_line,
10743 x_update_window_begin,
10744 x_update_window_end,
10745 x_cursor_to,
10746 x_flush,
10747 #ifdef XFlush
10748 x_flush,
10749 #else
10750 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10751 #endif
10752 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10753 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10754 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10755 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10756 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10757 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10758 x_per_char_metric,
10759 x_encode_char,
10760 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10761 x_draw_glyph_string,
10762 x_define_frame_cursor,
10763 x_clear_frame_area,
10764 x_draw_window_cursor,
10765 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10766 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10767 };
10768
10769 void
10770 x_initialize ()
10771 {
10772 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10773
10774 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10775 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10776 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10777 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10778 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10779 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10780 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10781 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10782 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10783 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10784 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10785 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10786 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10787 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10788 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10789 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10790 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10791 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10792
10793 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10794 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10795 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10796 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10797 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10798 off the bottom */
10799 baud_rate = 19200;
10800
10801 x_noop_count = 0;
10802 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10803 any_help_event_p = 0;
10804 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10805
10806 #ifdef USE_GTK
10807 current_count = -1;
10808 #endif
10809
10810 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10811 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10812
10813 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10814 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10815
10816 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10817
10818 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10819 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10820 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10821 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10822 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10823 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10824 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10825
10826 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10827
10828 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10829 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10830 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10831 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10832 widgets don't behave normally. */
10833 {
10834 EMACS_TIME interval;
10835 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10836 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10837 }
10838 #endif
10839
10840 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10841 #ifndef USE_GTK
10842 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10843 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10844 #endif
10845 #endif
10846
10847 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10848 original error handler. */
10849 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10850 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10851
10852 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10853 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10854 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10855 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10856
10857 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10858 }
10859
10860
10861 void
10862 syms_of_xterm ()
10863 {
10864 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10865 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10866
10867 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10868 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10869
10870 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10871 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10872
10873 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10874 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10875
10876 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10877 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10878 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10879 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10880
10881 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10882 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10883
10884 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10885 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10886 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10887 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10888 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10889 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10890 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10891
10892 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10893 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10894 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10895 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10896 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10897 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10898 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10899 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10900 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10901
10902 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10903 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10904 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10905 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10906 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10907 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10908 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10909 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10910 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10911 #elif USE_GTK
10912 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10913 #else
10914 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10915 #endif
10916 #else
10917 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10918 #endif
10919
10920 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10921 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10922
10923 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10924 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10925 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10926 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10927 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10928 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10929 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10930 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10931 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10932
10933 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10934 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10935 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10936 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10937 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10938 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10939
10940 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10941 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10942 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10943 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10944 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10945 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10946
10947 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10948 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10949 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10950 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10951 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10952 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10953
10954 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10955 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10956 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10957 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10958 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10959 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10960
10961 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10962 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10963 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10964 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10965 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10966 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10967 }
10968
10969 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10970
10971 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10972 (do not change this comment) */